Mercurial > emacs
comparison etc/NEWS @ 90428:a8190f7e546e
Merge from emacs--devo--0
Patches applied:
* emacs--devo--0 (patch 285-296)
- Update from CVS
- Merge from gnus--rel--5.10
- Update from CVS: admin/FOR-RELEASE: Update refcard section.
* gnus--rel--5.10 (patch 102-104)
- Update from CVS
Revision: emacs@sv.gnu.org/emacs--unicode--0--patch-64
author | Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org> |
---|---|
date | Wed, 07 Jun 2006 18:05:10 +0000 |
parents | a5812696f7bf 2f0ef040dfe3 |
children | 138027c8c982 |
comparison
equal
deleted
inserted
replaced
90427:ddb25860d044 | 90428:a8190f7e546e |
---|---|
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21 | 1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2006-06-04 |
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 | 2 Copyright (C) 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 |
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc. | 3 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
4 See the end for copying conditions. | 4 See the end for copying conditions. |
5 | 5 |
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org. | 6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org. |
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS | 7 If possible, use M-x report-emacs-bug. |
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling | 8 |
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n. | 9 This file is about changes in emacs version 22. |
10 | |
11 See files NEWS.21, NEWS.20, NEWS.19, NEWS.18, and NEWS.1-17 for changes | |
12 in older emacs versions. | |
13 | |
14 You can narrow news to a specific version by calling `view-emacs-news' | |
15 with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n. | |
10 | 16 |
11 Temporary note: | 17 Temporary note: |
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated. | 18 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated. |
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for. | 19 --- means no change in the manuals is called for. |
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or --- | 20 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or --- |
145 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian. | 151 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian. |
146 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup | 152 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup |
147 doesn't automatically select the right one. | 153 doesn't automatically select the right one. |
148 | 154 |
149 --- | 155 --- |
156 ** A Portuguese translation of Emacs' reference card has been added. | |
157 Its name is `pt-br-refcard.tex'. The corresponding PostScript file is | |
158 also included. | |
159 | |
160 | |
161 --- | |
150 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available. | 162 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available. |
151 | 163 |
152 --- | 164 --- |
153 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand. | 165 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand. |
154 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure | 166 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure |
826 it remains unchanged. | 838 it remains unchanged. |
827 | 839 |
828 +++ | 840 +++ |
829 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'. | 841 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'. |
830 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical | 842 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical |
831 elements are deleted. | 843 elements are deleted from the history list. |
832 | 844 |
833 ** Redisplay changes: | 845 ** Redisplay changes: |
834 | 846 |
835 +++ | 847 +++ |
836 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode. | 848 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode. |
1055 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'. | 1067 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'. |
1056 | 1068 |
1057 --- | 1069 --- |
1058 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can | 1070 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can |
1059 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32). | 1071 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32). |
1072 | |
1073 +++ | |
1074 *** The menu bar for Motif/Lesstif/Lucid/Gtk+ can be navigated with keys. | |
1075 Pressing F10 shows the first menu in the menu bar. Navigation is done with | |
1076 the arrow keys, select with the return key and cancel with the escape keys. | |
1060 | 1077 |
1061 +++ | 1078 +++ |
1062 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have | 1079 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have |
1063 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example | 1080 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example |
1064 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'. | 1081 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'. |
1145 | 1162 |
1146 +++ | 1163 +++ |
1147 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default. | 1164 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default. |
1148 | 1165 |
1149 ** Multilingual Environment (Mule) changes: | 1166 ** Multilingual Environment (Mule) changes: |
1167 | |
1168 *** You can disable character translation for a file using the -*- | |
1169 construct. Include `enable-character-translation: nil' inside the | |
1170 -*-...-*- to disable any character translation that may happen by | |
1171 various global and per-coding-system translation tables. You can also | |
1172 specify it in a local variable list at the end of the file. For | |
1173 shortcut, instead of using this long variable name, you can append the | |
1174 character "!" at the end of coding-system name specified in -*- | |
1175 construct or in a local variable list. For example, if a file has the | |
1176 following header, it is decoded by the coding system `iso-latin-1' | |
1177 without any character translation: | |
1178 ;; -*- coding: iso-latin-1!; -*- | |
1150 | 1179 |
1151 --- | 1180 --- |
1152 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup | 1181 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup |
1153 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale | 1182 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale |
1154 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines. | 1183 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines. |
1366 +++ | 1395 +++ |
1367 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps | 1396 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps |
1368 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer. | 1397 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer. |
1369 | 1398 |
1370 +++ | 1399 +++ |
1400 *** The Dired command `dired-goto-file' is now bound to j, not M-g. | |
1401 This is to avoid hiding the global key binding of M-g. | |
1402 | |
1403 +++ | |
1371 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now | 1404 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now |
1372 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded | 1405 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded |
1373 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards | 1406 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards |
1374 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the | 1407 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the |
1375 double quotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent | 1408 double quotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent |
1376 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'. | 1409 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'. |
1377 | 1410 |
1378 +++ | 1411 +++ |
1379 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name | 1412 *** In Dired, the w command now stores the current line's file name |
1380 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names. | 1413 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, it stores the absolute file name. |
1381 | 1414 |
1382 +++ | 1415 +++ |
1383 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode. | 1416 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode. |
1384 | 1417 |
1385 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command | 1418 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command |
2055 (`scheme-expand-current-form'). The commands actually sent to the Scheme | 2088 (`scheme-expand-current-form'). The commands actually sent to the Scheme |
2056 subprocess are controlled by the user options `scheme-trace-command', | 2089 subprocess are controlled by the user options `scheme-trace-command', |
2057 `scheme-untrace-command' and `scheme-expand-current-form'. | 2090 `scheme-untrace-command' and `scheme-expand-current-form'. |
2058 | 2091 |
2059 --- | 2092 --- |
2060 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp, BSD make and imake. | 2093 ** Changes in Makefile mode |
2094 | |
2095 *** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp, BSD make and imake. | |
2061 | 2096 |
2062 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter three | 2097 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter three |
2063 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable | 2098 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable |
2064 faces. | 2099 faces. |
2100 | |
2101 *** The variable `makefile-query-one-target-method' has been renamed | |
2102 to `makefile-query-one-target-method-function'. The old name is still | |
2103 available as alias. | |
2065 | 2104 |
2066 +++ | 2105 +++ |
2067 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top | 2106 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top |
2068 of the file that precede the first header line. | 2107 of the file that precede the first header line. |
2069 | 2108 |
2676 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style, | 2715 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style, |
2677 i.e., there is always a closing tag. | 2716 i.e., there is always a closing tag. |
2678 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis | 2717 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis |
2679 from the file name or buffer contents. | 2718 from the file name or buffer contents. |
2680 | 2719 |
2720 *** The variable `sgml-transformation' has been renamed to | |
2721 `sgml-transformation-function'. The old name is still available as | |
2722 alias. | |
2723 | |
2681 +++ | 2724 +++ |
2682 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support. | 2725 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support. |
2683 | 2726 |
2684 ** TeX modes: | 2727 ** TeX modes: |
2685 | 2728 |
2752 *** The variables `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert' and | 2795 *** The variables `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert' and |
2753 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert' have been renamed to | 2796 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert' have been renamed to |
2754 `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert-function' and | 2797 `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert-function' and |
2755 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert-function'. The old names are | 2798 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert-function'. The old names are |
2756 still available as aliases. | 2799 still available as aliases. |
2800 | |
2801 ** In Artist mode the variable `artist-text-renderer' has been | |
2802 renamed to `artist-text-renderer-function'. The old name is still | |
2803 available as alias. | |
2757 | 2804 |
2758 +++ | 2805 +++ |
2759 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now | 2806 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now |
2760 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l' | 2807 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l' |
2761 and `C-c C-r'. | 2808 and `C-c C-r'. |
3364 | 3411 |
3365 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS | 3412 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS |
3366 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'. | 3413 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'. |
3367 | 3414 |
3368 --- | 3415 --- |
3369 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction. | 3416 ** Changes in Skeleton |
3417 | |
3418 *** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction. | |
3370 | 3419 |
3371 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer | 3420 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer |
3372 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark | 3421 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark |
3373 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The | 3422 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The |
3374 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along | 3423 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along |
3375 with other details of skeleton construction. | 3424 with other details of skeleton construction. |
3376 | 3425 |
3426 *** The variables `skeleton-transformation', `skeleton-filter', and | |
3427 `skeleton-pair-filter' have been renamed to | |
3428 `skeleton-transformation-function', `skeleton-filter-function', and | |
3429 `skeleton-pair-filter-function'. The old names are still available | |
3430 as aliases. | |
3431 | |
3377 --- | 3432 --- |
3378 ** Hideshow mode changes | 3433 ** Hideshow mode changes |
3379 | 3434 |
3380 *** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay | 3435 *** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay |
3381 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch | 3436 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch |
3481 --- | 3536 --- |
3482 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead. | 3537 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead. |
3483 | 3538 |
3484 --- | 3539 --- |
3485 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted. | 3540 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted. |
3541 | |
3542 ** Ewoc changes | |
3543 | |
3544 *** The new function `ewoc-delete' deletes specified nodes. | |
3545 | |
3546 *** `ewoc-create' now takes optional arg NOSEP, which inhibits insertion of | |
3547 a newline after each pretty-printed entry and after the header and footer. | |
3548 This allows you to create multiple-entry ewocs on a single line and to | |
3549 effect "invisible" nodes by arranging for the pretty-printer to not print | |
3550 anything for those nodes. | |
3551 | |
3552 For example, these two sequences of expressions behave identically: | |
3553 | |
3554 ;; NOSEP nil | |
3555 (defun PP (data) (insert (format "%S" data))) | |
3556 (ewoc-create 'PP "start\n") | |
3557 | |
3558 ;; NOSEP t | |
3559 (defun PP (data) (insert (format "%S\n" data))) | |
3560 (ewoc-create 'PP "start\n\n" "\n" t) | |
3561 | |
3486 | 3562 |
3487 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems | 3563 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems |
3488 | 3564 |
3489 +++ | 3565 +++ |
3490 ** The HOME directory defaults to Application Data under the user profile. | 3566 ** The HOME directory defaults to Application Data under the user profile. |
3598 ** The variable `mac-command-key-is-meta' is obsolete. Use | 3674 ** The variable `mac-command-key-is-meta' is obsolete. Use |
3599 `mac-command-modifier' and `mac-option-modifier' instead. | 3675 `mac-command-modifier' and `mac-option-modifier' instead. |
3600 | 3676 |
3601 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1 | 3677 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1 |
3602 | 3678 |
3679 ** The function find-operation-coding-system accepts a cons (FILENAME | |
3680 . BUFFER) in an argument correponding to the target. | |
3681 | |
3603 --- | 3682 --- |
3604 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have | 3683 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have |
3605 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead. | 3684 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead. |
3606 | 3685 |
3607 +++ | 3686 +++ |
3628 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed. | 3707 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed. |
3629 | 3708 |
3630 +++ | 3709 +++ |
3631 ** The variable `memory-full' now remains t until | 3710 ** The variable `memory-full' now remains t until |
3632 there is no longer a shortage of memory. | 3711 there is no longer a shortage of memory. |
3712 | |
3633 | 3713 |
3634 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1 | 3714 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1 |
3635 | 3715 |
3636 ** General Lisp changes: | 3716 ** General Lisp changes: |
3637 | 3717 |
4274 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now | 4354 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now |
4275 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as | 4355 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as |
4276 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless. | 4356 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless. |
4277 | 4357 |
4278 +++ | 4358 +++ |
4279 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW. | |
4280 | |
4281 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file. | |
4282 | |
4283 +++ | |
4284 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return | 4359 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return |
4285 a list of two integers, instead of a cons. | 4360 a list of two integers, instead of a cons. |
4286 | 4361 |
4287 +++ | 4362 +++ |
4288 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which | 4363 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which |
4372 +++ | 4447 +++ |
4373 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which | 4448 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which |
4374 was selected when entering the minibuffer. | 4449 was selected when entering the minibuffer. |
4375 | 4450 |
4376 +++ | 4451 +++ |
4377 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL | |
4378 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones. | |
4379 | |
4380 +++ | |
4381 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which | 4452 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which |
4382 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satisfy. The | 4453 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satisfy. The |
4383 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument | 4454 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument |
4384 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this | 4455 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this |
4385 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list. | 4456 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list. |
4396 +++ | 4467 +++ |
4397 *** The new function `read-directory-name' is for reading a directory name. | 4468 *** The new function `read-directory-name' is for reading a directory name. |
4398 | 4469 |
4399 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better | 4470 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better |
4400 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories. | 4471 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories. |
4472 | |
4473 +++ | |
4474 *** The new variable `history-add-new-input' specifies whether to add new | |
4475 elements in history. If set to nil, minibuffer reading functions don't | |
4476 add new elements to the history list, so it is possible to do this | |
4477 afterwards by calling `add-to-history' explicitly. | |
4401 | 4478 |
4402 ** Completion changes: | 4479 ** Completion changes: |
4403 | 4480 |
4404 +++ | 4481 +++ |
4405 *** The new function `minibuffer-completion-contents' returns the contents | 4482 *** The new function `minibuffer-completion-contents' returns the contents |
5670 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a | 5747 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a |
5671 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does | 5748 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does |
5672 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument. | 5749 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument. |
5673 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals | 5750 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals |
5674 an error if the argument actually returns differing values. | 5751 an error if the argument actually returns differing values. |
5752 | |
5753 | |
5675 | 5754 |
5676 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3 | |
5677 | |
5678 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has | |
5679 been added. | |
5680 | |
5681 | |
5682 * Changes in Emacs 21.3 | |
5683 | |
5684 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems | |
5685 with Custom. | |
5686 | |
5687 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters | |
5688 as mule-utf-8. | |
5689 | |
5690 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically | |
5691 in UTF-8 locales). | |
5692 | |
5693 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in | |
5694 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the | |
5695 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' | |
5696 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation | |
5697 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding | |
5698 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that | |
5699 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but | |
5700 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read | |
5701 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable. | |
5702 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on. | |
5703 | |
5704 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of | |
5705 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'. | |
5706 | |
5707 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to | |
5708 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using | |
5709 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding | |
5710 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually | |
5711 contrary to the compound text specification. | |
5712 | |
5713 | |
5714 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2 | |
5715 | |
5716 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added. | |
5717 | |
5718 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added. | |
5719 | |
5720 | |
5721 * Changes in Emacs 21.2 | |
5722 | |
5723 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections. | |
5724 | |
5725 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in | |
5726 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the | |
5727 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste | |
5728 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system | |
5729 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system. | |
5730 | |
5731 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay' | |
5732 were changed. | |
5733 | |
5734 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs | |
5735 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode. | |
5736 | |
5737 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from | |
5738 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode, | |
5739 instead of using default-major-mode. | |
5740 | |
5741 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave | |
5742 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far | |
5743 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t | |
5744 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it | |
5745 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option | |
5746 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes | |
5747 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does. | |
5748 | |
5749 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the | |
5750 NEWS. | |
5751 | |
5752 | |
5753 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2 | |
5754 | |
5755 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively | |
5756 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up, | |
5757 and the latter now controls scrolling down. | |
5758 | |
5759 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can | |
5760 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output. | |
5761 | |
5762 | |
5763 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1 | |
5764 | |
5765 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and | |
5766 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra | |
5767 charsets in this release. | |
5768 | |
5769 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added. | |
5770 | |
5771 ** Support for LynxOS has been added. | |
5772 | |
5773 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for | |
5774 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure' | |
5775 to list them. | |
5776 | |
5777 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which | |
5778 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the | |
5779 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to | |
5780 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any | |
5781 necessary changes to unexec. | |
5782 | |
5783 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit | |
5784 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available. | |
5785 | |
5786 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs | |
5787 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available. | |
5788 | |
5789 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using | |
5790 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary. | |
5791 | |
5792 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement | |
5793 all of the new display features described below. The port currently | |
5794 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the | |
5795 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the | |
5796 description of aspects specific to the Mac. | |
5797 | |
5798 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the | |
5799 new display features described below. | |
5800 | |
5801 | |
5802 * Changes in Emacs 21.1 | |
5803 | |
5804 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine. | |
5805 | |
5806 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height. | |
5807 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing | |
5808 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height | |
5809 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in | |
5810 the text. | |
5811 | |
5812 ** Emacs has a new face implementation. | |
5813 | |
5814 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the | |
5815 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family, | |
5816 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify. | |
5817 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together | |
5818 specify a font. | |
5819 | |
5820 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts. | |
5821 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found | |
5822 under Lisp changes, below. | |
5823 | |
5824 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames. | |
5825 | |
5826 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors. | |
5827 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if | |
5828 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and | |
5829 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it. | |
5830 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face | |
5831 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored | |
5832 on terminals. | |
5833 | |
5834 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now | |
5835 supported on character terminals. | |
5836 | |
5837 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of | |
5838 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the | |
5839 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on | |
5840 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option. | |
5841 | |
5842 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X. | |
5843 | |
5844 ** Sound support | |
5845 | |
5846 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware | |
5847 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently | |
5848 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au). | |
5849 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable | |
5850 sound support. | |
5851 | |
5852 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate. | |
5853 | |
5854 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are | |
5855 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it | |
5856 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum | |
5857 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables: | |
5858 | |
5859 - User option: max-mini-window-height | |
5860 | |
5861 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a | |
5862 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it | |
5863 specifies a number of lines. | |
5864 | |
5865 Default is 0.25. | |
5866 | |
5867 - User option: resize-mini-windows | |
5868 | |
5869 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always | |
5870 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows | |
5871 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk | |
5872 again. | |
5873 | |
5874 Default is `grow-only'. | |
5875 | |
5876 ** LessTif support. | |
5877 | |
5878 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see | |
5879 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later. | |
5880 | |
5881 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog. | |
5882 | |
5883 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name | |
5884 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is | |
5885 non-nil. | |
5886 | |
5887 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported. | |
5888 | |
5889 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version | |
5890 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a | |
5891 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog. | |
5892 | |
5893 ** Toolkit scroll bars. | |
5894 | |
5895 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for | |
5896 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when | |
5897 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll | |
5898 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll | |
5899 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring | |
5900 Emacs. | |
5901 | |
5902 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how | |
5903 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from | |
5904 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your | |
5905 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a | |
5906 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take | |
5907 `s/freebsd.h' as an example. | |
5908 | |
5909 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take | |
5910 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the | |
5911 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on | |
5912 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your | |
5913 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO', | |
5914 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file. | |
5915 | |
5916 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or | |
5917 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO. | |
5918 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's | |
5919 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since | |
5920 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually. | |
5921 | |
5922 ** Tool bar support. | |
5923 | |
5924 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details | |
5925 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level | |
5926 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is | |
5927 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved | |
5928 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome | |
5929 icons will be used. | |
5930 | |
5931 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons | |
5932 for specific modes (with copyright assignments). | |
5933 | |
5934 ** Tooltips. | |
5935 | |
5936 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current | |
5937 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can | |
5938 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'. | |
5939 | |
5940 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated, | |
5941 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with | |
5942 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the | |
5943 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'. | |
5944 | |
5945 ** Automatic Hscrolling | |
5946 | |
5947 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if | |
5948 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be | |
5949 customized. | |
5950 | |
5951 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or | |
5952 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound | |
5953 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll | |
5954 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more | |
5955 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc. | |
5956 | |
5957 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor | |
5958 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is | |
5959 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option | |
5960 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the | |
5961 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if | |
5962 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown. | |
5963 | |
5964 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display | |
5965 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The | |
5966 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by | |
5967 customizing face `fringe'. | |
5968 | |
5969 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default. | |
5970 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'. | |
5971 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D | |
5972 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line | |
5973 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of | |
5974 the window to be partially obscured.) | |
5975 | |
5976 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older | |
5977 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated. | |
5978 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be | |
5979 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face. | |
5980 | |
5981 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line. | |
5982 | |
5983 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all | |
5984 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a | |
5985 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the | |
5986 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is | |
5987 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you | |
5988 have enabled one. | |
5989 | |
5990 Currently, the following actions have been defined: | |
5991 | |
5992 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer. | |
5993 | |
5994 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer. | |
5995 | |
5996 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or | |
5997 `*') toggles the status. | |
5998 | |
5999 - Mouse-3 on the major mode name displays a major mode menu. | |
6000 | |
6001 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu. | |
6002 | |
6003 ** Hourglass pointer | |
6004 | |
6005 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can | |
6006 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'. | |
6007 | |
6008 ** Blinking cursor | |
6009 | |
6010 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on | |
6011 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking | |
6012 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in | |
6013 the group `cursor'. | |
6014 | |
6015 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'. | |
6016 | |
6017 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is | |
6018 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification. | |
6019 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more | |
6020 details. | |
6021 | |
6022 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't | |
6023 have to do anything to activate it. | |
6024 | |
6025 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed. | |
6026 | |
6027 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to | |
6028 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys. | |
6029 | |
6030 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen | |
6031 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace | |
6032 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the | |
6033 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to | |
6034 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On | |
6035 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two | |
6036 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is | |
6037 set to nil, and these keys delete backward. | |
6038 | |
6039 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes | |
6040 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the | |
6041 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via | |
6042 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on | |
6043 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only | |
6044 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys. | |
6045 | |
6046 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode | |
6047 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys. | |
6048 | |
6049 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been | |
6050 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a | |
6051 buffer by default. | |
6052 | |
6053 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the | |
6054 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the | |
6055 beginning and end of the buffer. | |
6056 | |
6057 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the | |
6058 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is | |
6059 signaled. | |
6060 | |
6061 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init | |
6062 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer. | |
6063 | |
6064 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't | |
6065 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change | |
6066 this behavior. | |
6067 | |
6068 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte | |
6069 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let | |
6070 Emacs dump core. | |
6071 | |
6072 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus. | |
6073 | |
6074 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit | |
6075 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for | |
6076 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif. | |
6077 | |
6078 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is | |
6079 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is | |
6080 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus. | |
6081 | |
6082 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set | |
6083 using that menu. | |
6084 | |
6085 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace. | |
6086 | |
6087 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing | |
6088 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is | |
6089 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy | |
6090 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not | |
6091 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the | |
6092 whitespace. | |
6093 | |
6094 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes | |
6095 all frames except the selected one. | |
6096 | |
6097 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to | |
6098 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting. | |
6099 | |
6100 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs | |
6101 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window), | |
6102 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled. | |
6103 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option | |
6104 `Info-use-header-line'. | |
6105 | |
6106 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card | |
6107 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex', | |
6108 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included. | |
6109 | |
6110 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available. | |
6111 | |
6112 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is | |
6113 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in | |
6114 `fr-drdref.tex'. | |
6115 | |
6116 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not | |
6117 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the | |
6118 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode | |
6119 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu. | |
6120 | |
6121 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize. | |
6122 | |
6123 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path' | |
6124 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still | |
6125 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your | |
6126 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general. | |
6127 | |
6128 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at | |
6129 point in a pop-up window. | |
6130 | |
6131 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse) | |
6132 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or | |
6133 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'. | |
6134 | |
6135 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount' | |
6136 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled. | |
6137 | |
6138 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a | |
6139 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory. | |
6140 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.) | |
6141 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location. | |
6142 | |
6143 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively. | |
6144 | |
6145 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil | |
6146 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights. | |
6147 | |
6148 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the | |
6149 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add | |
6150 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'. | |
6151 | |
6152 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will | |
6153 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is | |
6154 non-nil. | |
6155 | |
6156 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be | |
6157 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a | |
6158 file that is already visited under a different name. | |
6159 | |
6160 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to | |
6161 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size. | |
6162 | |
6163 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name | |
6164 and displays information about that. | |
6165 | |
6166 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular | |
6167 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination. | |
6168 | |
6169 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to | |
6170 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a | |
6171 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be | |
6172 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the | |
6173 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode | |
6174 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'. | |
6175 | |
6176 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is | |
6177 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'. | |
6178 | |
6179 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if | |
6180 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer | |
6181 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or | |
6182 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and | |
6183 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment, | |
6184 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding. | |
6185 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system. | |
6186 | |
6187 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have | |
6188 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'. | |
6189 | |
6190 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding | |
6191 system for keyboard input. | |
6192 | |
6193 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs' | |
6194 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's | |
6195 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores | |
6196 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is | |
6197 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you | |
6198 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to | |
6199 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c | |
6200 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1 | |
6201 RET C-x C-f filename RET. | |
6202 | |
6203 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the | |
6204 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'. | |
6205 | |
6206 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and | |
6207 displays all characters in that character set. | |
6208 | |
6209 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based | |
6210 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8. | |
6211 | |
6212 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment | |
6213 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the | |
6214 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup. | |
6215 | |
6216 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'. | |
6217 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets | |
6218 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign). | |
6219 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have | |
6220 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts. | |
6221 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only) | |
6222 and Polish `slash'. | |
6223 | |
6224 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'. | |
6225 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations | |
6226 of the tutorial. | |
6227 | |
6228 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for | |
6229 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs | |
6230 Lisp Coding Convention". | |
6231 | |
6232 new command old-binding | |
6233 --- ------- ----------- | |
6234 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5 | |
6235 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5 | |
6236 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5 | |
6237 | |
6238 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged | |
6239 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged | |
6240 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged | |
6241 | |
6242 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3 | |
6243 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6 | |
6244 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7 | |
6245 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8 | |
6246 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged | |
6247 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2 | |
6248 | |
6249 ** There are new Leim input methods. | |
6250 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix", | |
6251 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim | |
6252 package. | |
6253 | |
6254 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the | |
6255 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus | |
6256 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating | |
6257 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input | |
6258 "`", you must type "=q". | |
6259 | |
6260 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO | |
6261 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display | |
6262 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of | |
6263 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a | |
6264 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this | |
6265 on. | |
6266 | |
6267 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based | |
6268 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill, | |
6269 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region | |
6270 commenting with the variable `comment-style'. | |
6271 | |
6272 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and | |
6273 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail | |
6274 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the | |
6275 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive. | |
6276 | |
6277 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines | |
6278 on the display using several methods | |
6279 | |
6280 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be | |
6281 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should | |
6282 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames. | |
6283 | |
6284 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is | |
6285 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter. | |
6286 | |
6287 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line. | |
6288 | |
6289 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is | |
6290 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only. | |
6291 | |
6292 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create | |
6293 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The | |
6294 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c, | |
6295 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window. | |
6296 | |
6297 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and | |
6298 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups, | |
6299 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory. | |
6300 | |
6301 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1 | |
6302 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities. | |
6303 | |
6304 ** New X resources recognized | |
6305 | |
6306 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies | |
6307 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode | |
6308 is useful for debugging X problems. | |
6309 | |
6310 Example: | |
6311 | |
6312 emacs.synchronous: true | |
6313 | |
6314 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the | |
6315 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of | |
6316 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class, | |
6317 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid | |
6318 visual class names are | |
6319 | |
6320 TrueColor | |
6321 PseudoColor | |
6322 DirectColor | |
6323 StaticColor | |
6324 GrayScale | |
6325 StaticGray | |
6326 | |
6327 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e. | |
6328 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same | |
6329 meaning. | |
6330 | |
6331 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes | |
6332 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If | |
6333 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default | |
6334 visual. | |
6335 | |
6336 Example: | |
6337 | |
6338 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8 | |
6339 | |
6340 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap', | |
6341 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the | |
6342 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized | |
6343 resource values are `true' or `on'. | |
6344 | |
6345 Example: | |
6346 | |
6347 emacs.privateColormap: true | |
6348 | |
6349 ** Faces and frame parameters. | |
6350 | |
6351 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'. | |
6352 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and | |
6353 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face | |
6354 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color' | |
6355 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise | |
6356 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame | |
6357 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'. | |
6358 | |
6359 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the | |
6360 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters | |
6361 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the | |
6362 `default' face and vice versa. | |
6363 | |
6364 ** New face `menu'. | |
6365 | |
6366 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus. | |
6367 | |
6368 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction. | |
6369 | |
6370 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for | |
6371 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma | |
6372 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies | |
6373 the screen gamma of a frame's display. | |
6374 | |
6375 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result | |
6376 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD | |
6377 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2). | |
6378 | |
6379 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class | |
6380 `ScreenGamma'. | |
6381 | |
6382 ** Tabs and variable-width text. | |
6383 | |
6384 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is | |
6385 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is | |
6386 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears. | |
6387 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts. | |
6388 | |
6389 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar | |
6390 | |
6391 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin". | |
6392 | |
6393 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5 | |
6394 | |
6395 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the | |
6396 LessTif/Motif one. | |
6397 | |
6398 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in | |
6399 LessTif and Motif. | |
6400 | |
6401 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X. | |
6402 | |
6403 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be | |
6404 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set | |
6405 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value. | |
6406 | |
6407 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a | |
6408 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less). | |
6409 | |
6410 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable | |
6411 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this | |
6412 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'. | |
6413 | |
6414 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method. | |
6415 | |
6416 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the | |
6417 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a | |
6418 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that | |
6419 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window. | |
6420 | |
6421 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the | |
6422 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a | |
6423 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that | |
6424 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window. | |
6425 | |
6426 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either | |
6427 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET. | |
6428 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special | |
6429 buffers. | |
6430 | |
6431 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history. | |
6432 | |
6433 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows | |
6434 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing | |
6435 `directory-abbrev-alist'. | |
6436 | |
6437 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives | |
6438 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be | |
6439 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this | |
6440 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system | |
6441 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership, | |
6442 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them. | |
6443 | |
6444 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature. | |
6445 | |
6446 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces, | |
6447 notably at the end of lines. | |
6448 | |
6449 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted | |
6450 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way. | |
6451 | |
6452 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'. | |
6453 | |
6454 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle', | |
6455 but inserts text instead of replacing it. | |
6456 | |
6457 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like | |
6458 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated | |
6459 after each match to get the replacement text. | |
6460 | |
6461 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets | |
6462 you edit the replacement string. | |
6463 | |
6464 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB' | |
6465 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases | |
6466 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol. | |
6467 | |
6468 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value. | |
6469 | |
6470 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set | |
6471 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it. | |
6472 | |
6473 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains | |
6474 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and | |
6475 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus | |
6476 displayed by Emacs now have help strings. | |
6477 | |
6478 -- | |
6479 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to | |
6480 read mail from the menu etc. | |
6481 | |
6482 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows. | |
6483 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on | |
6484 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made | |
6485 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now. | |
6486 | |
6487 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the | |
6488 MS-DOS version of Emacs. | |
6489 | |
6490 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version | |
6491 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons. | |
6492 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons | |
6493 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons, | |
6494 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version | |
6495 of Emacs. | |
6496 | |
6497 ** Customize changes | |
6498 | |
6499 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the | |
6500 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to | |
6501 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that | |
6502 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in | |
6503 earlier versions of Emacs. | |
6504 | |
6505 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill | |
6506 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the | |
6507 default). | |
6508 | |
6509 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it | |
6510 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init | |
6511 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would | |
6512 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init | |
6513 file. | |
6514 | |
6515 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it | |
6516 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to | |
6517 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are | |
6518 already in your init file. | |
6519 | |
6520 ** New features in evaluation commands | |
6521 | |
6522 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp | |
6523 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables | |
6524 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new | |
6525 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level, | |
6526 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error. | |
6527 | |
6528 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4 | |
6529 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most | |
6530 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if | |
6531 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is | |
6532 printed). | |
6533 | |
6534 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated | |
6535 printed representation and an unabbreviated one. | |
6536 | |
6537 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error | |
6538 during evaluation produces a backtrace. | |
6539 | |
6540 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments | |
6541 code when called with a prefix argument. | |
6542 | |
6543 ** CC mode changes. | |
6544 | |
6545 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with | |
6546 current user setups (although it's believed that these | |
6547 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances). | |
6548 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled | |
6549 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward | |
6550 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this | |
6551 release. | |
6552 | |
6553 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone. | |
6554 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode | |
6555 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much | |
6556 confusion. | |
6557 | |
6558 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the | |
6559 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for | |
6560 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't | |
6561 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable. | |
6562 | |
6563 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall. | |
6564 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list: | |
6565 | |
6566 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening | |
6567 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)". | |
6568 | |
6569 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening | |
6570 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function. | |
6571 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the | |
6572 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()". | |
6573 | |
6574 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation. | |
6575 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made | |
6576 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an | |
6577 earlier statement. An example: | |
6578 | |
6579 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++) | |
6580 if (a[i]) | |
6581 res += a[i]->offset; | |
6582 else | |
6583 | |
6584 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it | |
6585 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after | |
6586 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's | |
6587 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of | |
6588 the preceding "if". | |
6589 | |
6590 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on | |
6591 by default. | |
6592 | |
6593 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings. | |
6594 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which | |
6595 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing | |
6596 documentation or other natural language text. | |
6597 | |
6598 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that | |
6599 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in | |
6600 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline | |
6601 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed | |
6602 to other strings that typically contain format specifications, | |
6603 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses | |
6604 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway. | |
6605 | |
6606 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode. | |
6607 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the | |
6608 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in | |
6609 comment prefixes and paragraph starts. | |
6610 | |
6611 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific. | |
6612 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment | |
6613 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This | |
6614 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in | |
6615 Pike mode only. | |
6616 | |
6617 *** Better handling of syntactic errors. | |
6618 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been | |
6619 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message | |
6620 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the | |
6621 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no | |
6622 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while | |
6623 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error | |
6624 is reported afterwards. | |
6625 | |
6626 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns. | |
6627 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by | |
6628 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element. | |
6629 | |
6630 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation. | |
6631 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending | |
6632 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now | |
6633 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some | |
6634 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the | |
6635 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the | |
6636 groundwork. | |
6637 | |
6638 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t. | |
6639 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior | |
6640 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for | |
6641 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might | |
6642 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't | |
6643 have to bother. | |
6644 | |
6645 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing | |
6646 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally | |
6647 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session. | |
6648 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of | |
6649 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java" | |
6650 by default) to override the global settings made by the user. | |
6651 | |
6652 *** New initialization procedure for the style system. | |
6653 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the | |
6654 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now | |
6655 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This | |
6656 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific | |
6657 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it | |
6658 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with | |
6659 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file. | |
6660 | |
6661 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new | |
6662 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from | |
6663 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting | |
6664 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described | |
6665 above. | |
6666 | |
6667 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only* | |
6668 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode | |
6669 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a | |
6670 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style --- | |
6671 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style | |
6672 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values | |
6673 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the | |
6674 function documentation for more info. | |
6675 | |
6676 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users, | |
6677 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or | |
6678 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is | |
6679 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well, | |
6680 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system | |
6681 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current | |
6682 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and | |
6683 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set. | |
6684 | |
6685 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.) | |
6686 | |
6687 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable. | |
6688 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior. | |
6689 | |
6690 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style | |
6691 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be | |
6692 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when | |
6693 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the | |
6694 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the | |
6695 style system. | |
6696 | |
6697 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior. | |
6698 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set | |
6699 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back | |
6700 as far as possible. | |
6701 | |
6702 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling. | |
6703 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the | |
6704 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new | |
6705 chapter about this in the manual. | |
6706 | |
6707 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations. | |
6708 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly | |
6709 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's | |
6710 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and | |
6711 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses. | |
6712 | |
6713 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix. | |
6714 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable | |
6715 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings. | |
6716 | |
6717 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode. | |
6718 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments. | |
6719 | |
6720 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC | |
6721 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/). | |
6722 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use | |
6723 inside CC Mode. | |
6724 | |
6725 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that | |
6726 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match | |
6727 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is | |
6728 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/ | |
6729 cc-mode/). | |
6730 | |
6731 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and | |
6732 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and | |
6733 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the | |
6734 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as | |
6735 they were before the filling. | |
6736 | |
6737 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling. | |
6738 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in | |
6739 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string | |
6740 literals. | |
6741 | |
6742 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break. | |
6743 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line | |
6744 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If | |
6745 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to | |
6746 this function. | |
6747 | |
6748 *** Fixes to IDL mode. | |
6749 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant | |
6750 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a | |
6751 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword. | |
6752 Thanks to Eric Eide. | |
6753 | |
6754 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style. | |
6755 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when | |
6756 opening braces hangs and when they don't. | |
6757 | |
6758 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block. | |
6759 | |
6760 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block. | |
6761 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a | |
6762 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates, | |
6763 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments. | |
6764 | |
6765 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the | |
6766 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in | |
6767 the column specified by comment-column. | |
6768 | |
6769 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments. | |
6770 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation | |
6771 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line | |
6772 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that | |
6773 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally | |
6774 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation. | |
6775 | |
6776 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start | |
6777 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup | |
6778 arguments. | |
6779 | |
6780 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings. | |
6781 | |
6782 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions. | |
6783 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional. | |
6784 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are | |
6785 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don | |
6786 Provan). | |
6787 | |
6788 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations. | |
6789 | |
6790 ** Dired changes | |
6791 | |
6792 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete | |
6793 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default | |
6794 is, delete only empty directories. | |
6795 | |
6796 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy | |
6797 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not | |
6798 copy directories recursively. | |
6799 | |
6800 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?' | |
6801 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with | |
6802 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually. | |
6803 | |
6804 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a') | |
6805 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or | |
6806 directory. | |
6807 | |
6808 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows | |
6809 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on. | |
6810 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so | |
6811 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as | |
6812 accurate or inaccurate as it is. | |
6813 | |
6814 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R' | |
6815 from ls switches. | |
6816 | |
6817 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use | |
6818 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename, | |
6819 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single | |
6820 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files. | |
6821 | |
6822 ** Gnus changes. | |
6823 | |
6824 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in | |
6825 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment, | |
6826 internationalization and mail-fetching. | |
6827 | |
6828 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the | |
6829 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone. | |
6830 | |
6831 If you used procmail like in | |
6832 | |
6833 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t) | |
6834 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail) | |
6835 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/") | |
6836 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in") | |
6837 | |
6838 this now has changed to | |
6839 | |
6840 (setq mail-sources | |
6841 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/" | |
6842 :suffix ".in"))) | |
6843 | |
6844 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods -> | |
6845 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources | |
6846 | |
6847 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of | |
6848 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details. | |
6849 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no | |
6850 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities. | |
6851 | |
6852 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to | |
6853 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was | |
6854 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier. | |
6855 | |
6856 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many | |
6857 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There | |
6858 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is | |
6859 now just a compatibility layer. | |
6860 | |
6861 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in | |
6862 Gnus facilities. | |
6863 | |
6864 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be | |
6865 called to position point. | |
6866 | |
6867 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in | |
6868 summary buffers and NOV files. | |
6869 | |
6870 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number | |
6871 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added. | |
6872 | |
6873 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a | |
6874 subtly different manner. | |
6875 | |
6876 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive | |
6877 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with | |
6878 ever-changing layouts. | |
6879 | |
6880 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap. | |
6881 | |
6882 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support. | |
6883 | |
6884 ** Changes in Texinfo mode. | |
6885 | |
6886 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo | |
6887 macros | |
6888 | |
6889 Key binding Macro | |
6890 ------------------------- | |
6891 C-c C-c C-s @strong | |
6892 C-c C-c C-e @emph | |
6893 C-c C-c u @uref | |
6894 C-c C-c q @quotation | |
6895 C-c C-c m @email | |
6896 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block> | |
6897 M-RET @item | |
6898 | |
6899 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context. | |
6900 | |
6901 ** Changes in Outline mode. | |
6902 | |
6903 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command | |
6904 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to | |
6905 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents. | |
6906 | |
6907 ** Changes to Emacs Server | |
6908 | |
6909 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do | |
6910 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers | |
6911 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with | |
6912 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which | |
6913 buffers to kill, as before. | |
6914 | |
6915 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client, | |
6916 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in | |
6917 this way. | |
6918 | |
6919 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options | |
6920 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE. | |
6921 | |
6922 ** Changes to Show Paren mode. | |
6923 | |
6924 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property. | |
6925 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to | |
6926 use. Default is 1000. | |
6927 | |
6928 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren | |
6929 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes). | |
6930 | |
6931 ** Changes to hideshow.el | |
6932 | |
6933 *** Generalized block selection and traversal | |
6934 | |
6935 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings), | |
6936 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp | |
6937 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate. | |
6938 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'. | |
6939 | |
6940 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active, | |
6941 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can | |
6942 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of | |
6943 the open block. | |
6944 | |
6945 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a | |
6946 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of | |
6947 the normal block-hiding function. | |
6948 | |
6949 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed. | |
6950 | |
6951 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions, | |
6952 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix | |
6953 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation | |
6954 for `hs-minor-mode'. | |
6955 | |
6956 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and | |
6957 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t. | |
6958 | |
6959 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions | |
6960 | |
6961 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes | |
6962 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making | |
6963 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions. | |
6964 | |
6965 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the | |
6966 current buffer. | |
6967 | |
6968 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries | |
6969 in a log file. | |
6970 | |
6971 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log | |
6972 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil. | |
6973 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's | |
6974 version number is performed based on regular expressions from | |
6975 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized. | |
6976 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file. | |
6977 | |
6978 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting. | |
6979 | |
6980 ** Changes to cmuscheme | |
6981 | |
6982 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed | |
6983 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el. | |
6984 | |
6985 ** Changes in Font Lock | |
6986 | |
6987 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove | |
6988 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode. | |
6989 | |
6990 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should | |
6991 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults. | |
6992 | |
6993 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose | |
6994 the face used for each string/comment. | |
6995 | |
6996 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'. | |
6997 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code". | |
6998 | |
6999 ** Changes to Shell mode | |
7000 | |
7001 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer | |
7002 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a | |
7003 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a | |
7004 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name). | |
7005 | |
7006 ** Comint (subshell) changes | |
7007 | |
7008 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which | |
7009 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc. | |
7010 | |
7011 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters. | |
7012 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and | |
7013 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the | |
7014 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character, | |
7015 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to | |
7016 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default. | |
7017 | |
7018 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp' | |
7019 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which | |
7020 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the | |
7021 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use | |
7022 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line, | |
7023 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this | |
7024 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option | |
7025 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'. | |
7026 | |
7027 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes | |
7028 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers. | |
7029 | |
7030 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and | |
7031 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current | |
7032 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer. | |
7033 | |
7034 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like | |
7035 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of | |
7036 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer. | |
7037 | |
7038 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts, | |
7039 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features, | |
7040 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'. | |
7041 | |
7042 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s') | |
7043 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix | |
7044 argument, it appends to the file. | |
7045 | |
7046 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output' | |
7047 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for | |
7048 compatibility. | |
7049 | |
7050 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input | |
7051 ring (history). | |
7052 | |
7053 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for | |
7054 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp | |
7055 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#". | |
7056 | |
7057 ** Changes to Rmail mode | |
7058 | |
7059 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be | |
7060 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when | |
7061 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the | |
7062 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default, | |
7063 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself | |
7064 as correspondent. | |
7065 | |
7066 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect | |
7067 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a | |
7068 regexp matching your mail addresses. | |
7069 | |
7070 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how | |
7071 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an | |
7072 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation | |
7073 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask | |
7074 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p. | |
7075 | |
7076 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg, | |
7077 like `j'. | |
7078 | |
7079 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that | |
7080 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a | |
7081 digest message. | |
7082 | |
7083 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies | |
7084 in which folder to put messages automatically. | |
7085 | |
7086 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message | |
7087 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly | |
7088 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header. | |
7089 | |
7090 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify | |
7091 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address. | |
7092 | |
7093 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to | |
7094 use the -f option when sending mail. | |
7095 | |
7096 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the | |
7097 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in | |
7098 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'. | |
7099 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded | |
7100 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be | |
7101 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file. | |
7102 | |
7103 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system | |
7104 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable | |
7105 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system. | |
7106 | |
7107 ** Changes to TeX mode | |
7108 | |
7109 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to | |
7110 `latex-mode'. | |
7111 | |
7112 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm. | |
7113 | |
7114 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs. | |
7115 | |
7116 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode. | |
7117 | |
7118 ** Changes to RefTeX mode | |
7119 | |
7120 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be | |
7121 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys. | |
7122 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default | |
7123 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically | |
7124 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries | |
7125 can be edited from that buffer. | |
7126 | |
7127 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several | |
7128 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or | |
7129 `A' to use all marked entries). | |
7130 | |
7131 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce | |
7132 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used. | |
7133 | |
7134 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &' | |
7135 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order | |
7136 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has | |
7137 been cited. | |
7138 | |
7139 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings. | |
7140 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading | |
7141 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `(' | |
7142 in column 1 are always made leaves. | |
7143 | |
7144 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks) | |
7145 has the following new features: | |
7146 | |
7147 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern | |
7148 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like | |
7149 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable | |
7150 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns. | |
7151 | |
7152 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This | |
7153 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source | |
7154 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the | |
7155 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching | |
7156 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it | |
7157 defaults to 1. | |
7158 | |
7159 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in | |
7160 file names. | |
7161 | |
7162 ** Ispell changes | |
7163 | |
7164 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if | |
7165 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it | |
7166 spell-checks the current buffer. | |
7167 | |
7168 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been | |
7169 added. | |
7170 | |
7171 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling | |
7172 correction is made and re-checked. | |
7173 | |
7174 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added. | |
7175 | |
7176 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some | |
7177 cases. | |
7178 | |
7179 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict | |
7180 on syntax errors. | |
7181 | |
7182 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the | |
7183 end of the buffer. | |
7184 | |
7185 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs. | |
7186 | |
7187 ** Makefile mode changes | |
7188 | |
7189 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'. | |
7190 | |
7191 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when | |
7192 Fontlock mode is active. | |
7193 | |
7194 ** Isearch changes | |
7195 | |
7196 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history, | |
7197 so that searches can be resumed. | |
7198 | |
7199 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r, | |
7200 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys | |
7201 that started the search. | |
7202 | |
7203 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current | |
7204 selection into the search string rather than giving an error. | |
7205 | |
7206 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search. | |
7207 | |
7208 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable | |
7209 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current | |
7210 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as | |
7211 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are | |
7212 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to | |
7213 `secondary-selection'. | |
7214 | |
7215 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor | |
7216 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search. | |
7217 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion | |
7218 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its | |
7219 usual snappy response. | |
7220 | |
7221 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for | |
7222 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is | |
7223 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x | |
7224 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'. | |
7225 | |
7226 ** VC Changes | |
7227 | |
7228 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it | |
7229 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp | |
7230 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism | |
7231 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has | |
7232 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable | |
7233 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify | |
7234 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file, | |
7235 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the | |
7236 file is registered in that backend. | |
7237 | |
7238 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed | |
7239 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the | |
7240 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for | |
7241 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then | |
7242 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen. | |
7243 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete. | |
7244 | |
7245 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC | |
7246 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for | |
7247 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables | |
7248 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS | |
7249 where it doesn't make sense.) | |
7250 | |
7251 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also | |
7252 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude | |
7253 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now. | |
7254 | |
7255 *** General Changes | |
7256 | |
7257 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding | |
7258 checks are always done now. | |
7259 | |
7260 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control | |
7261 operations. | |
7262 | |
7263 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'. | |
7264 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'. | |
7265 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'. | |
7266 | |
7267 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the | |
7268 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the | |
7269 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into | |
7270 the working file (``merge news''). | |
7271 | |
7272 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r | |
7273 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work | |
7274 downwards. | |
7275 | |
7276 *** Multiple Backends | |
7277 | |
7278 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is | |
7279 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS | |
7280 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally | |
7281 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your | |
7282 local RCS archives. | |
7283 | |
7284 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example) | |
7285 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote'' | |
7286 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of | |
7287 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.) | |
7288 | |
7289 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing | |
7290 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as | |
7291 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend | |
7292 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the | |
7293 current revision number from the more remote backend. | |
7294 | |
7295 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to | |
7296 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change | |
7297 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to | |
7298 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally. | |
7299 | |
7300 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your | |
7301 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the | |
7302 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry | |
7303 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file. | |
7304 | |
7305 *** Changes for CVS | |
7306 | |
7307 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the | |
7308 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in | |
7309 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined | |
7310 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a | |
7311 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts | |
7312 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC | |
7313 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files. | |
7314 | |
7315 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of | |
7316 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and | |
7317 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without | |
7318 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version | |
7319 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version | |
7320 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~ | |
7321 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter | |
7322 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other, | |
7323 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted | |
7324 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS, | |
7325 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file | |
7326 name.) | |
7327 | |
7328 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the | |
7329 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit. | |
7330 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to | |
7331 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the | |
7332 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an | |
7333 entire directory tree. | |
7334 | |
7335 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call | |
7336 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option | |
7337 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are | |
7338 "watched" by other developers.) | |
7339 | |
7340 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r | |
7341 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give | |
7342 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update', | |
7343 starting at the given directory. | |
7344 | |
7345 *** Lisp Changes in VC | |
7346 | |
7347 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now | |
7348 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a | |
7349 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and | |
7350 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for | |
7351 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which | |
7352 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top | |
7353 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library, | |
7354 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol | |
7355 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'. | |
7356 | |
7357 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT | |
7358 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more | |
7359 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs. | |
7360 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information. | |
7361 | |
7362 ** New modes and packages | |
7363 | |
7364 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode' | |
7365 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when | |
7366 the default is not applicable. | |
7367 | |
7368 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines, | |
7369 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The | |
7370 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \. | |
7371 | |
7372 Features are: | |
7373 | |
7374 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is | |
7375 drawn, like this: | \ / | |
7376 --+-- X | |
7377 | / \ | |
7378 | |
7379 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the | |
7380 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If | |
7381 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a | |
7382 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will | |
7383 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line | |
7384 you are drawing. | |
7385 | |
7386 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight) | |
7387 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >. | |
7388 | |
7389 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by | |
7390 flood-filling. | |
7391 | |
7392 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular | |
7393 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be | |
7394 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in | |
7395 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa. | |
7396 | |
7397 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can | |
7398 also do without the mouse. | |
7399 | |
7400 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to | |
7401 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares | |
7402 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your | |
7403 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio, | |
7404 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round. | |
7405 | |
7406 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented: | |
7407 | |
7408 lines straight-lines | |
7409 rectangles squares | |
7410 poly-lines straight poly-lines | |
7411 ellipses circles | |
7412 text (see-thru) text (overwrite) | |
7413 spray-can setting size for spraying | |
7414 vaporize line vaporize lines | |
7415 erase characters erase rectangles | |
7416 | |
7417 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or | |
7418 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in | |
7419 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while | |
7420 drawing. | |
7421 | |
7422 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines | |
7423 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are | |
7424 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired | |
7425 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>. | |
7426 | |
7427 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this | |
7428 can be turned off). | |
7429 | |
7430 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell | |
7431 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it. | |
7432 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp | |
7433 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports | |
7434 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It | |
7435 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of | |
7436 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been | |
7437 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell, | |
7438 all within the scope of your Emacs process. | |
7439 | |
7440 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time | |
7441 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the | |
7442 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working | |
7443 on certain projects. | |
7444 | |
7445 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches | |
7446 of interactively entered regexps. For example, | |
7447 | |
7448 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET | |
7449 | |
7450 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background | |
7451 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are | |
7452 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting. | |
7453 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of | |
7454 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the | |
7455 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the | |
7456 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches | |
7457 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match. | |
7458 | |
7459 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when | |
7460 Emacs is idle. | |
7461 | |
7462 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text | |
7463 fragments in accordance with the current major mode. | |
7464 | |
7465 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML | |
7466 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however. | |
7467 | |
7468 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el | |
7469 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should | |
7470 be more robust while offering the same functionality. | |
7471 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only | |
7472 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary. | |
7473 | |
7474 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags | |
7475 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a | |
7476 separate Texinfo file. | |
7477 | |
7478 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or | |
7479 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument) | |
7480 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with | |
7481 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to | |
7482 enter check-in log messages. | |
7483 | |
7484 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages | |
7485 without invoking external programs. | |
7486 | |
7487 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp | |
7488 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike | |
7489 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it | |
7490 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and | |
7491 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available. | |
7492 | |
7493 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man | |
7494 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does. | |
7495 | |
7496 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for | |
7497 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback. | |
7498 | |
7499 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for | |
7500 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in | |
7501 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing. | |
7502 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so | |
7503 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a | |
7504 single step. | |
7505 | |
7506 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like | |
7507 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will | |
7508 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp | |
7509 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits. | |
7510 | |
7511 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes | |
7512 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without | |
7513 actually modifying content of a buffer. | |
7514 | |
7515 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in | |
7516 PostScript. | |
7517 | |
7518 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc. | |
7519 | |
7520 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements: | |
7521 | |
7522 ; comment (until end of line) | |
7523 A non-terminal | |
7524 "C" terminal | |
7525 ?C? special | |
7526 $A default non-terminal | |
7527 $"C" default terminal | |
7528 $?C? default special | |
7529 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body) | |
7530 C D sequence (C occurs before D) | |
7531 C | D alternative (C or D occurs) | |
7532 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal) | |
7533 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times) | |
7534 (C) group (expression C is grouped together) | |
7535 [C] optional (C may or not occurs) | |
7536 C+ one or more occurrences of C | |
7537 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C | |
7538 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C | |
7539 {C} zero or more occurrences of C | |
7540 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}* | |
7541 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}* | |
7542 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*] | |
7543 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*] | |
7544 | |
7545 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it. | |
7546 | |
7547 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x | |
7548 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions, | |
7549 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for | |
7550 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the | |
7551 equal signs of assignments. | |
7552 | |
7553 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting | |
7554 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'. | |
7555 | |
7556 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to | |
7557 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a | |
7558 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'. | |
7559 | |
7560 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp. | |
7561 | |
7562 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to | |
7563 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it | |
7564 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators, | |
7565 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should | |
7566 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool | |
7567 which answers different needs. | |
7568 | |
7569 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights | |
7570 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside | |
7571 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of | |
7572 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with | |
7573 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode | |
7574 to be enabled. | |
7575 | |
7576 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files | |
7577 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS. | |
7578 | |
7579 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game. | |
7580 | |
7581 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the | |
7582 current line in the current buffer. It also provides | |
7583 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers. | |
7584 | |
7585 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties. | |
7586 | |
7587 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and | |
7588 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will | |
7589 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to | |
7590 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This | |
7591 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground | |
7592 and background colors. | |
7593 | |
7594 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object | |
7595 Pascal) language. | |
7596 | |
7597 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on | |
7598 the text at point. | |
7599 | |
7600 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases. | |
7601 | |
7602 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures. | |
7603 | |
7604 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus | |
7605 whitespace in a file. | |
7606 | |
7607 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript | |
7608 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including | |
7609 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for | |
7610 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and | |
7611 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out / | |
7612 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal | |
7613 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu. | |
7614 | |
7615 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle. | |
7616 | |
7617 Here is an example of columns: | |
7618 | |
7619 horse apple bus | |
7620 dog pineapple car EXTRA | |
7621 porcupine strawberry airplane | |
7622 | |
7623 Doing the following settings: | |
7624 | |
7625 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ") | |
7626 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]") | |
7627 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ") | |
7628 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t") | |
7629 | |
7630 | |
7631 Selecting the lines above and typing: | |
7632 | |
7633 M-x delimit-columns-region | |
7634 | |
7635 It results: | |
7636 | |
7637 [ horse , apple , bus , ] | |
7638 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ] | |
7639 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ] | |
7640 | |
7641 delim-col has the following options: | |
7642 | |
7643 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted | |
7644 before all columns. | |
7645 | |
7646 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted | |
7647 between each column. | |
7648 | |
7649 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted | |
7650 after all columns. | |
7651 | |
7652 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates | |
7653 each column. | |
7654 | |
7655 delim-col has the following commands: | |
7656 | |
7657 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region. | |
7658 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle. | |
7659 | |
7660 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were | |
7661 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a | |
7662 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the | |
7663 recent file list can be displayed: | |
7664 | |
7665 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules. | |
7666 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending. | |
7667 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory | |
7668 | |
7669 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to | |
7670 dynamically change the menu appearance. | |
7671 | |
7672 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header | |
7673 text. | |
7674 | |
7675 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use | |
7676 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't | |
7677 specific to Message mode. | |
7678 | |
7679 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for | |
7680 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files | |
7681 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'. | |
7682 | |
7683 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user | |
7684 interface to access directory servers using different directory | |
7685 protocols. It has a separate manual. | |
7686 | |
7687 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files | |
7688 for Autoconf, selected automatically. | |
7689 | |
7690 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows. | |
7691 | |
7692 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the | |
7693 minibuffer with completion. | |
7694 | |
7695 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration | |
7696 with the diary features. | |
7697 | |
7698 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby | |
7699 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting. | |
7700 | |
7701 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto | |
7702 Fill mode. | |
7703 | |
7704 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion | |
7705 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main | |
7706 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning | |
7707 they can be profiled, debugged, etc. | |
7708 | |
7709 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files. | |
7710 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension | |
7711 `.g'. | |
7712 | |
7713 ** Changes in sort.el | |
7714 | |
7715 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0' | |
7716 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The | |
7717 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default | |
7718 numeric base. | |
7719 | |
7720 ** Changes to Ange-ftp | |
7721 | |
7722 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file | |
7723 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash | |
7724 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.) | |
7725 | |
7726 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive | |
7727 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that. | |
7728 | |
7729 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which | |
7730 output ^M at the end of lines. | |
7731 | |
7732 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor | |
7733 mode `iswitchb-mode'. | |
7734 | |
7735 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore. | |
7736 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with | |
7737 `(msb-mode 1)'. | |
7738 | |
7739 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom | |
7740 group. | |
7741 | |
7742 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the | |
7743 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values | |
7744 are recognized: | |
7745 | |
7746 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space; | |
7747 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces; | |
7748 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines; | |
7749 nil -- just delete one character. | |
7750 | |
7751 Default value is `untabify'. | |
7752 | |
7753 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.] | |
7754 | |
7755 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face | |
7756 symbol, not double-quoted. | |
7757 | |
7758 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future | |
7759 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline, | |
7760 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been | |
7761 moved to lisp/obsolete. | |
7762 | |
7763 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el. | |
7764 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the | |
7765 `auto-compression-mode' command. | |
7766 | |
7767 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for | |
7768 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and | |
7769 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser. | |
7770 | |
7771 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to | |
7772 `browse-url-new-window-flag'. | |
7773 | |
7774 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now | |
7775 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode. | |
7776 | |
7777 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It | |
7778 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia. | |
7779 | |
7780 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM | |
7781 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode, | |
7782 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the | |
7783 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands | |
7784 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a | |
7785 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes. | |
7786 | |
7787 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts | |
7788 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer. | |
7789 | |
7790 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters. | |
7791 | |
7792 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the | |
7793 file you are visiting in Hexl mode. | |
7794 | |
7795 ** Shell script mode changes. | |
7796 | |
7797 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells | |
7798 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and | |
7799 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style. | |
7800 | |
7801 ** Etags changes. | |
7802 | |
7803 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c. | |
7804 | |
7805 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now | |
7806 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with | |
7807 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out. | |
7808 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains | |
7809 a regular expression. The manual contains details. | |
7810 | |
7811 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function | |
7812 declarations when given the --declarations option. | |
7813 | |
7814 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form | |
7815 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator. | |
7816 | |
7817 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags | |
7818 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or | |
7819 `template' keywords. | |
7820 | |
7821 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in | |
7822 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels. | |
7823 | |
7824 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and | |
7825 types. | |
7826 | |
7827 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged. | |
7828 | |
7829 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface". | |
7830 | |
7831 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs | |
7832 are now tagged. | |
7833 | |
7834 *** In makefiles, tags the targets. | |
7835 | |
7836 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local | |
7837 variables are tagged. | |
7838 | |
7839 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags. | |
7840 | |
7841 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is | |
7842 for PSWrap. | |
7843 | |
7844 ** Changes in etags.el | |
7845 | |
7846 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make | |
7847 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default | |
7848 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search. | |
7849 | |
7850 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting | |
7851 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions. | |
7852 | |
7853 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE | |
7854 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes | |
7855 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist, | |
7856 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used. | |
7857 | |
7858 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH. | |
7859 | |
7860 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags | |
7861 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol. | |
7862 | |
7863 A useful example value for this variable might be something like: | |
7864 | |
7865 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray) | |
7866 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray) | |
7867 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray)) | |
7868 | |
7869 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance | |
7870 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos. | |
7871 | |
7872 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the | |
7873 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer. | |
7874 | |
7875 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself. | |
7876 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c | |
7877 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c", | |
7878 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name, | |
7879 point will go to the beginning of the file. | |
7880 | |
7881 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if | |
7882 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search | |
7883 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files. | |
7884 | |
7885 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point | |
7886 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is | |
7887 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring. | |
7888 | |
7889 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to | |
7890 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now | |
7891 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings. | |
7892 | |
7893 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'. | |
7894 | |
7895 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file. | |
7896 | |
7897 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps' | |
7898 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular | |
7899 expression from that list, are not checked. | |
7900 | |
7901 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files. | |
7902 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file, | |
7903 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert | |
7904 the buffer, just like for the local files. | |
7905 | |
7906 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer. | |
7907 | |
7908 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now | |
7909 displays local abbrevs, only. | |
7910 | |
7911 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping | |
7912 paragraphs filled as you modify them. | |
7913 | |
7914 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse | |
7915 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value | |
7916 is measured in pixels. | |
7917 | |
7918 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files | |
7919 to be visited as images. | |
7920 | |
7921 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command' | |
7922 were added to compile.el. | |
7923 | |
7924 ** Withdrawn packages | |
7925 | |
7926 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same | |
7927 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions. | |
7928 | |
7929 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed. | |
7930 | |
7931 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed. | |
7932 | |
7933 | |
7934 * Incompatible Lisp changes | |
7935 | |
7936 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and | |
7937 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference. | |
7938 See the sections below for details. | |
7939 | |
7940 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom | |
7941 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties. | |
7942 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties' | |
7943 to remove the properties of the copy. | |
7944 | |
7945 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code | |
7946 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability) | |
7947 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from | |
7948 these properties are active. | |
7949 | |
7950 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search | |
7951 ranges may affect some code. | |
7952 | |
7953 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook | |
7954 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might | |
7955 make a difference to some code. | |
7956 | |
7957 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which | |
7958 operates on the minibuffer. | |
7959 | |
7960 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic' | |
7961 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce | |
7962 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters | |
7963 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results). | |
7964 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate | |
7965 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading | |
7966 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE | |
7967 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program | |
7968 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte | |
7969 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as | |
7970 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in | |
7971 the buffer as multibyte characters. | |
7972 | |
7973 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal | |
7974 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only | |
7975 appropriate for reading truly binary files. | |
7976 | |
7977 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and | |
7978 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use | |
7979 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead. | |
7980 | |
7981 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as | |
7982 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat', | |
7983 such as `mapconcat'. | |
7984 | |
7985 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte | |
7986 string. | |
7987 | |
7988 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of | |
7989 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new | |
7990 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than | |
7991 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard | |
7992 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes | |
7993 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule | |
7994 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will | |
7995 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21. | |
7996 | |
7997 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal. | |
7998 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be | |
7999 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should | |
8000 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and | |
8001 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the | |
8002 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It | |
8003 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to | |
8004 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well | |
8005 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value | |
8006 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed. | |
8007 | |
8008 | |
8009 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual, | |
8010 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.) | |
8011 | |
8012 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all. | |
8013 | |
8014 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el | |
8015 allows the animated display of strings. | |
8016 | |
8017 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the | |
8018 interactive form of a function. | |
8019 | |
8020 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies | |
8021 between custom options. Example: | |
8022 | |
8023 (defcustom default-input-method nil | |
8024 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string). | |
8025 This is the input method activated automatically by the command | |
8026 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])." | |
8027 :group 'mule | |
8028 :type '(choice (const nil) string) | |
8029 :set-after '(current-language-environment)) | |
8030 | |
8031 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after | |
8032 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears | |
8033 first in a custom-set-variables statement. | |
8034 | |
8035 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of | |
8036 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no | |
8037 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated | |
8038 (signal or normal termination). | |
8039 | |
8040 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements | |
8041 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package. | |
8042 | |
8043 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil | |
8044 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights. | |
8045 | |
8046 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies | |
8047 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font. | |
8048 | |
8049 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum". | |
8050 | |
8051 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually | |
8052 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame | |
8053 being deleted. | |
8054 | |
8055 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg. | |
8056 | |
8057 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed. | |
8058 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of | |
8059 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends | |
8060 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is | |
8061 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's | |
8062 charset. | |
8063 | |
8064 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in | |
8065 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the | |
8066 message. | |
8067 | |
8068 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an | |
8069 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled. | |
8070 | |
8071 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced | |
8072 with the more general `:mask' property. | |
8073 | |
8074 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's. | |
8075 | |
8076 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a | |
8077 backslash. | |
8078 | |
8079 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs | |
8080 is running in batch mode. For example, | |
8081 | |
8082 (message "%s" (read t)) | |
8083 | |
8084 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result | |
8085 to standard output. | |
8086 | |
8087 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list', | |
8088 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional. | |
8089 | |
8090 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer' | |
8091 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new | |
8092 frame or window. | |
8093 | |
8094 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences | |
8095 were added | |
8096 | |
8097 - Function: remove ELT SEQ | |
8098 | |
8099 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be | |
8100 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'. | |
8101 | |
8102 - Function: remq ELT LIST | |
8103 | |
8104 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The | |
8105 comparison is done with `eq'. | |
8106 | |
8107 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings. | |
8108 | |
8109 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table | |
8110 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and | |
8111 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'. | |
8112 | |
8113 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string | |
8114 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may | |
8115 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary. | |
8116 | |
8117 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function | |
8118 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string. | |
8119 | |
8120 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the | |
8121 function was declared obsolete. | |
8122 | |
8123 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is | |
8124 retained as an alias). | |
8125 | |
8126 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and | |
8127 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form. | |
8128 | |
8129 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined | |
8130 | |
8131 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF | |
8132 | |
8133 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or | |
8134 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use | |
8135 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window, | |
8136 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the | |
8137 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t | |
8138 means never include the minibuffer window. | |
8139 | |
8140 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows | |
8141 | |
8142 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT | |
8143 | |
8144 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE. | |
8145 | |
8146 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows', | |
8147 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as | |
8148 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil | |
8149 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is | |
8150 returned. | |
8151 | |
8152 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even | |
8153 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff | |
8154 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the | |
8155 minibuffer even if it is active. | |
8156 | |
8157 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer | |
8158 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count | |
8159 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame | |
8160 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts, | |
8161 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you | |
8162 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window. | |
8163 | |
8164 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument. | |
8165 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above. | |
8166 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames. | |
8167 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames. | |
8168 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames. | |
8169 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame. | |
8170 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame. | |
8171 | |
8172 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and | |
8173 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional | |
8174 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed. | |
8175 | |
8176 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a | |
8177 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that | |
8178 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x. | |
8179 Default value is nil. | |
8180 | |
8181 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil, | |
8182 meaning no limit. | |
8183 | |
8184 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls | |
8185 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line | |
8186 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200. | |
8187 | |
8188 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred | |
8189 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and | |
8190 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified, | |
8191 | |
8192 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument | |
8193 list of a primitive. | |
8194 | |
8195 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps. | |
8196 | |
8197 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the | |
8198 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property. | |
8199 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather | |
8200 than replacing the local map. | |
8201 | |
8202 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and | |
8203 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been | |
8204 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' | |
8205 instead. | |
8206 | |
8207 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'. | |
8208 | |
8209 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments, | |
8210 as promised long ago. | |
8211 | |
8212 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float. | |
8213 | |
8214 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems | |
8215 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but | |
8216 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names. | |
8217 | |
8218 | |
8219 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features) | |
8220 | |
8221 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for | |
8222 regular expressions. | |
8223 | |
8224 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP | |
8225 | |
8226 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation. | |
8227 | |
8228 - Macro: rx SEXP | |
8229 | |
8230 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation. | |
8231 | |
8232 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp | |
8233 notation. | |
8234 | |
8235 STRING | |
8236 matches string STRING literally. | |
8237 | |
8238 CHAR | |
8239 matches character CHAR literally. | |
8240 | |
8241 `not-newline' | |
8242 matches any character except a newline. | |
8243 . | |
8244 `anything' | |
8245 matches any character | |
8246 | |
8247 `(any SET)' | |
8248 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string. | |
8249 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings. | |
8250 | |
8251 '(in SET)' | |
8252 like `any'. | |
8253 | |
8254 `(not (any SET))' | |
8255 matches any character not in SET | |
8256 | |
8257 `line-start' | |
8258 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line | |
8259 in the text being matched | |
8260 | |
8261 `line-end' | |
8262 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line | |
8263 | |
8264 `string-start' | |
8265 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the | |
8266 string being matched against. | |
8267 | |
8268 `string-end' | |
8269 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the | |
8270 string being matched against. | |
8271 | |
8272 `buffer-start' | |
8273 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the | |
8274 buffer being matched against. | |
8275 | |
8276 `buffer-end' | |
8277 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the | |
8278 buffer being matched against. | |
8279 | |
8280 `point' | |
8281 matches the empty string, but only at point. | |
8282 | |
8283 `word-start' | |
8284 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a | |
8285 word. | |
8286 | |
8287 `word-end' | |
8288 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word. | |
8289 | |
8290 `word-boundary' | |
8291 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a | |
8292 word. | |
8293 | |
8294 `(not word-boundary)' | |
8295 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a | |
8296 word. | |
8297 | |
8298 `digit' | |
8299 matches 0 through 9. | |
8300 | |
8301 `control' | |
8302 matches ASCII control characters. | |
8303 | |
8304 `hex-digit' | |
8305 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F. | |
8306 | |
8307 `blank' | |
8308 matches space and tab only. | |
8309 | |
8310 `graphic' | |
8311 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars, | |
8312 space, and DEL. | |
8313 | |
8314 `printing' | |
8315 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars | |
8316 and DEL. | |
8317 | |
8318 `alphanumeric' | |
8319 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters, | |
8320 it matches anything that has word syntax.) | |
8321 | |
8322 `letter' | |
8323 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters, | |
8324 it matches anything that has word syntax.) | |
8325 | |
8326 `ascii' | |
8327 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters. | |
8328 | |
8329 `nonascii' | |
8330 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters. | |
8331 | |
8332 `lower' | |
8333 matches anything lower-case. | |
8334 | |
8335 `upper' | |
8336 matches anything upper-case. | |
8337 | |
8338 `punctuation' | |
8339 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters, | |
8340 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.) | |
8341 | |
8342 `space' | |
8343 matches anything that has whitespace syntax. | |
8344 | |
8345 `word' | |
8346 matches anything that has word syntax. | |
8347 | |
8348 `(syntax SYNTAX)' | |
8349 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one | |
8350 of the following symbols. | |
8351 | |
8352 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation) | |
8353 `punctuation' (\\s.) | |
8354 `word' (\\sw) | |
8355 `symbol' (\\s_) | |
8356 `open-parenthesis' (\\s() | |
8357 `close-parenthesis' (\\s)) | |
8358 `expression-prefix' (\\s') | |
8359 `string-quote' (\\s\") | |
8360 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$) | |
8361 `escape' (\\s\\) | |
8362 `character-quote' (\\s/) | |
8363 `comment-start' (\\s<) | |
8364 `comment-end' (\\s>) | |
8365 | |
8366 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))' | |
8367 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX. | |
8368 | |
8369 `(category CATEGORY)' | |
8370 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be | |
8371 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols. | |
8372 | |
8373 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation) | |
8374 `base-vowel' (\\c1) | |
8375 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2) | |
8376 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3) | |
8377 `tone-mark' (\\c4) | |
8378 `symbol' (\\c5) | |
8379 `digit' (\\c6) | |
8380 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7) | |
8381 `vowel-sign' (\\c8) | |
8382 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9) | |
8383 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<) | |
8384 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>) | |
8385 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA) | |
8386 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC) | |
8387 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG) | |
8388 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH) | |
8389 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI) | |
8390 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK) | |
8391 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN) | |
8392 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY) | |
8393 `ascii' (\\ca) | |
8394 `arabic' (\\cb) | |
8395 `chinese' (\\cc) | |
8396 `ethiopic' (\\ce) | |
8397 `greek' (\\cg) | |
8398 `korean' (\\ch) | |
8399 `indian' (\\ci) | |
8400 `japanese' (\\cj) | |
8401 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck) | |
8402 `latin' (\\cl) | |
8403 `lao' (\\co) | |
8404 `tibetan' (\\cq) | |
8405 `japanese-roman' (\\cr) | |
8406 `thai' (\\ct) | |
8407 `vietnamese' (\\cv) | |
8408 `hebrew' (\\cw) | |
8409 `cyrillic' (\\cy) | |
8410 `can-break' (\\c|) | |
8411 | |
8412 `(not (category CATEGORY))' | |
8413 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY. | |
8414 | |
8415 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)' | |
8416 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc. | |
8417 | |
8418 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)' | |
8419 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end', | |
8420 `match-beginning', and `match-string'. | |
8421 | |
8422 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)' | |
8423 another name for `submatch'. | |
8424 | |
8425 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)' | |
8426 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all | |
8427 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting | |
8428 regular expression. | |
8429 | |
8430 `(minimal-match SEXP)' | |
8431 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching | |
8432 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they | |
8433 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can | |
8434 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible. | |
8435 | |
8436 `(maximal-match SEXP)' | |
8437 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default. | |
8438 | |
8439 `(zero-or-more SEXP)' | |
8440 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches. | |
8441 | |
8442 `(0+ SEXP)' | |
8443 like `zero-or-more'. | |
8444 | |
8445 `(* SEXP)' | |
8446 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp. | |
8447 | |
8448 `(*? SEXP)' | |
8449 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp. | |
8450 | |
8451 `(one-or-more SEXP)' | |
8452 matches one or more occurrences of A. | |
8453 | |
8454 `(1+ SEXP)' | |
8455 like `one-or-more'. | |
8456 | |
8457 `(+ SEXP)' | |
8458 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp. | |
8459 | |
8460 `(+? SEXP)' | |
8461 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp. | |
8462 | |
8463 `(zero-or-one SEXP)' | |
8464 matches zero or one occurrences of A. | |
8465 | |
8466 `(optional SEXP)' | |
8467 like `zero-or-one'. | |
8468 | |
8469 `(? SEXP)' | |
8470 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp. | |
8471 | |
8472 `(?? SEXP)' | |
8473 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp. | |
8474 | |
8475 `(repeat N SEXP)' | |
8476 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches. | |
8477 | |
8478 `(repeat N M SEXP)' | |
8479 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches. | |
8480 | |
8481 `(eval FORM)' | |
8482 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string, | |
8483 `regexp-quote' it. | |
8484 | |
8485 `(regexp REGEXP)' | |
8486 include REGEXP in string notation in the result. | |
8487 | |
8488 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default. | |
8489 | |
8490 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the | |
8491 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside | |
8492 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved | |
8493 restriction to be restored incorrectly. | |
8494 | |
8495 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include | |
8496 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list | |
8497 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a | |
8498 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer. | |
8499 | |
8500 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and | |
8501 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string | |
8502 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set. | |
8503 | |
8504 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is | |
8505 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern | |
8506 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character | |
8507 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if | |
8508 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the | |
8509 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra | |
8510 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset | |
8511 eight-bit-graphic. | |
8512 | |
8513 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables. | |
8514 | |
8515 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for | |
8516 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a | |
8517 character set as previously. | |
8518 | |
8519 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed. | |
8520 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function | |
8521 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER. | |
8522 | |
8523 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic | |
8524 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the | |
8525 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that | |
8526 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset. | |
8527 | |
8528 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family | |
8529 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font. | |
8530 | |
8531 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset | |
8532 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset | |
8533 "fontset-default". | |
8534 | |
8535 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second | |
8536 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets. | |
8537 | |
8538 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character | |
8539 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in | |
8540 buffers and strings. | |
8541 | |
8542 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite | |
8543 character' which is an independent character with a unique character | |
8544 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters' | |
8545 have been deleted: composite-char-component, | |
8546 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule, | |
8547 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete. | |
8548 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have | |
8549 also been deleted. | |
8550 | |
8551 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to | |
8552 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable | |
8553 `reference-point-alist' for more detail. | |
8554 | |
8555 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and | |
8556 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a | |
8557 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters | |
8558 may differ between buffer and string text. | |
8559 | |
8560 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END, | |
8561 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC. | |
8562 | |
8563 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition' | |
8564 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string. | |
8565 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property | |
8566 `composition' from STRING. | |
8567 | |
8568 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about | |
8569 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string. | |
8570 | |
8571 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as | |
8572 obsolete. | |
8573 | |
8574 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on | |
8575 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text. | |
8576 | |
8577 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff', | |
8578 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been | |
8579 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF, | |
8580 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively. | |
8581 | |
8582 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so | |
8583 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew, | |
8584 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are | |
8585 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text | |
8586 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be | |
8587 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system. | |
8588 | |
8589 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added. | |
8590 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For | |
8591 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system. | |
8592 | |
8593 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and | |
8594 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese | |
8595 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2. | |
8596 | |
8597 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15' | |
8598 have been introduced. | |
8599 | |
8600 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic' | |
8601 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and | |
8602 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of | |
8603 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the | |
8604 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the | |
8605 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for | |
8606 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string | |
8607 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to | |
8608 their multibyte equivalent. | |
8609 | |
8610 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to | |
8611 that offset in the file before writing. | |
8612 | |
8613 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and | |
8614 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode). | |
8615 | |
8616 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the | |
8617 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer | |
8618 from which the command was issued. | |
8619 | |
8620 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp', | |
8621 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp', | |
8622 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two | |
8623 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to | |
8624 operate on. | |
8625 | |
8626 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative | |
8627 to `window-buffer-height'. | |
8628 | |
8629 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW | |
8630 | |
8631 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END. | |
8632 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual | |
8633 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc. | |
8634 | |
8635 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max' | |
8636 respectively. | |
8637 | |
8638 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument | |
8639 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil. | |
8640 | |
8641 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for | |
8642 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so | |
8643 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters. | |
8644 | |
8645 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current | |
8646 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes | |
8647 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it | |
8648 is currently displayed in some window. | |
8649 | |
8650 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the | |
8651 argument function's results. | |
8652 | |
8653 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now | |
8654 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also, | |
8655 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs | |
8656 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte | |
8657 sequence). | |
8658 | |
8659 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body' | |
8660 header in the list of headers passed to it. | |
8661 | |
8662 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but | |
8663 ignores differences in case and text representation. | |
8664 | |
8665 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the | |
8666 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted | |
8667 as follows: | |
8668 | |
8669 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default) | |
8670 nil don't display a cursor | |
8671 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width | |
8672 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH | |
8673 others display a box cursor. | |
8674 | |
8675 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether | |
8676 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a | |
8677 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not | |
8678 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning. | |
8679 | |
8680 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax | |
8681 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to | |
8682 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table' | |
8683 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'. | |
8684 | |
8685 Example: | |
8686 | |
8687 (string-to-syntax "()") | |
8688 => (4 . 41) | |
8689 | |
8690 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases | |
8691 other than 10. | |
8692 | |
8693 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2). | |
8694 INTEGER optionally contains a sign. | |
8695 | |
8696 #b1111 | |
8697 => 15 | |
8698 #b-1111 | |
8699 => -15 | |
8700 | |
8701 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8). | |
8702 | |
8703 #o666 | |
8704 => 438 | |
8705 | |
8706 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16). | |
8707 | |
8708 #xbeef | |
8709 => 48815 | |
8710 | |
8711 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36. | |
8712 | |
8713 #2R-111 | |
8714 => -7 | |
8715 #25rah | |
8716 => 267 | |
8717 | |
8718 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of | |
8719 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC | |
8720 and isn't a string. | |
8721 | |
8722 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for | |
8723 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil | |
8724 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is | |
8725 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string. | |
8726 | |
8727 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience. | |
8728 | |
8729 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches | |
8730 for a regexp in a string. | |
8731 | |
8732 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook | |
8733 `mouse-position-function'. | |
8734 | |
8735 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers | |
8736 that don't fit into a Lisp integer. | |
8737 | |
8738 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed. | |
8739 Keywords are now always considered constants. | |
8740 | |
8741 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and | |
8742 returns it. | |
8743 | |
8744 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector | |
8745 returned by function `recent-keys'. | |
8746 | |
8747 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function' | |
8748 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns. | |
8749 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a | |
8750 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the | |
8751 mode. | |
8752 | |
8753 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument | |
8754 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'. | |
8755 | |
8756 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol | |
8757 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook | |
8758 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it | |
8759 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has | |
8760 been performed." | |
8761 | |
8762 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character, | |
8763 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the | |
8764 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done, | |
8765 then the self-inserting character is not inserted. | |
8766 | |
8767 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument. | |
8768 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray, | |
8769 and the function's value is nil if it is not found. | |
8770 | |
8771 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms | |
8772 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a | |
8773 specified table. | |
8774 | |
8775 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY) | |
8776 | |
8777 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of | |
8778 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the | |
8779 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is | |
8780 what BODY returns. | |
8781 | |
8782 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as | |
8783 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators. | |
8784 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the | |
8785 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet). | |
8786 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\'). | |
8787 | |
8788 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been | |
8789 removed since it wasn't used by anything. | |
8790 | |
8791 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required | |
8792 instead of being optional. | |
8793 | |
8794 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to | |
8795 modify read-only text. | |
8796 | |
8797 ** New functions and variables for locales. | |
8798 | |
8799 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and | |
8800 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and | |
8801 time functions like strftime. The new variables | |
8802 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system | |
8803 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions. | |
8804 | |
8805 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language | |
8806 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from | |
8807 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG | |
8808 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need | |
8809 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables | |
8810 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and | |
8811 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions. | |
8812 | |
8813 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments. | |
8814 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n' | |
8815 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment | |
8816 start sequences. | |
8817 | |
8818 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p' | |
8819 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology. | |
8820 | |
8821 ** New function `propertize' | |
8822 | |
8823 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct | |
8824 strings with text properties. | |
8825 | |
8826 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES | |
8827 | |
8828 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified | |
8829 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with | |
8830 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the | |
8831 specified value of that property. Example: | |
8832 | |
8833 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t) | |
8834 | |
8835 ** push and pop macros. | |
8836 | |
8837 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp | |
8838 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols | |
8839 as the place that holds the list to be changed. | |
8840 | |
8841 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value. | |
8842 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it | |
8843 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME). | |
8844 | |
8845 ** New dolist and dotimes macros. | |
8846 | |
8847 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp | |
8848 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. | |
8849 | |
8850 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...) | |
8851 Execute body once for each element of LIST, | |
8852 using the variable VAR to hold the current element. | |
8853 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted. | |
8854 | |
8855 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...) | |
8856 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0, | |
8857 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive. | |
8858 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted. | |
8859 | |
8860 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as | |
8861 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character | |
8862 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period | |
8863 or a sign. | |
8864 | |
8865 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9 | |
8866 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters | |
8867 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F. | |
8868 [:blank:] matches space and tab only | |
8869 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars, | |
8870 space, and DEL. | |
8871 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars | |
8872 and DEL. | |
8873 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits. | |
8874 (But at present, for multibyte characters, | |
8875 it matches anything that has word syntax.) | |
8876 [:alpha:] matches letters. | |
8877 (But at present, for multibyte characters, | |
8878 it matches anything that has word syntax.) | |
8879 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters. | |
8880 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters. | |
8881 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case. | |
8882 [:punct:] matches punctuation. | |
8883 (But at present, for multibyte characters, | |
8884 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.) | |
8885 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax. | |
8886 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case. | |
8887 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax. | |
8888 | |
8889 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables. | |
8890 | |
8891 The following functions are defined for hash tables: | |
8892 | |
8893 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS | |
8894 | |
8895 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments | |
8896 are optional. The following arguments are defined: | |
8897 | |
8898 :test TEST | |
8899 | |
8900 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'. | |
8901 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined, | |
8902 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'. | |
8903 | |
8904 :size SIZE | |
8905 | |
8906 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how | |
8907 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65. | |
8908 | |
8909 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE | |
8910 | |
8911 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes | |
8912 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old | |
8913 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float > | |
8914 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the | |
8915 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5. | |
8916 | |
8917 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD | |
8918 | |
8919 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the | |
8920 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) / | |
8921 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8. | |
8922 | |
8923 :weakness WEAK | |
8924 | |
8925 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value', | |
8926 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as | |
8927 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage | |
8928 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere | |
8929 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables. | |
8930 | |
8931 - Function: makehash &optional TEST | |
8932 | |
8933 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified. | |
8934 | |
8935 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE | |
8936 | |
8937 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object. | |
8938 | |
8939 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE | |
8940 | |
8941 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and | |
8942 values are shared. | |
8943 | |
8944 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE | |
8945 | |
8946 Returns the number of entries in TABLE. | |
8947 | |
8948 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE | |
8949 | |
8950 Returns the rehash size of TABLE. | |
8951 | |
8952 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE | |
8953 | |
8954 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE. | |
8955 | |
8956 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE | |
8957 | |
8958 Returns the size of TABLE. | |
8959 | |
8960 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE | |
8961 | |
8962 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys. | |
8963 | |
8964 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE | |
8965 | |
8966 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE. | |
8967 | |
8968 - Function: clrhash TABLE | |
8969 | |
8970 Clear TABLE. | |
8971 | |
8972 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT | |
8973 | |
8974 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if | |
8975 not found. | |
8976 | |
8977 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE | |
8978 | |
8979 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with | |
8980 another value, replace the old value with VALUE. | |
8981 | |
8982 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE | |
8983 | |
8984 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there. | |
8985 | |
8986 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE | |
8987 | |
8988 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two | |
8989 arguments KEY and VALUE. | |
8990 | |
8991 - Function: sxhash OBJ | |
8992 | |
8993 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ. | |
8994 | |
8995 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN | |
8996 | |
8997 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as | |
8998 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for | |
8999 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test | |
9000 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test' | |
9001 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN). | |
9002 | |
9003 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same. | |
9004 | |
9005 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash | |
9006 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of | |
9007 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers. | |
9008 | |
9009 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to | |
9010 be strings that are compared case-insensitively. | |
9011 | |
9012 (defun case-fold-string= (a b) | |
9013 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t)) | |
9014 | |
9015 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a) | |
9016 (sxhash (upcase a))) | |
9017 | |
9018 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string= | |
9019 'case-fold-string-hash)) | |
9020 | |
9021 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold) | |
9022 | |
9023 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure. | |
9024 | |
9025 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent | |
9026 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents | |
9027 a cons cell which is its own cdr. | |
9028 | |
9029 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure. | |
9030 | |
9031 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs | |
9032 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure. | |
9033 | |
9034 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or | |
9035 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the | |
9036 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it | |
9037 is too short to reach that column. | |
9038 | |
9039 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may | |
9040 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION | |
9041 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with | |
9042 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made. | |
9043 | |
9044 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters, | |
9045 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily | |
9046 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it. | |
9047 | |
9048 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument | |
9049 to specify which buffer to return the size of. | |
9050 | |
9051 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook | |
9052 calendar-move-hook after moving point. | |
9053 | |
9054 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a | |
9055 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be | |
9056 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If | |
9057 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use | |
9058 temporary-file-directory instead. | |
9059 | |
9060 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all | |
9061 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects | |
9062 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as | |
9063 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties. | |
9064 | |
9065 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the | |
9066 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value. | |
9067 | |
9068 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file. | |
9069 | |
9070 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually | |
9071 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error, | |
9072 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file. | |
9073 | |
9074 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region' | |
9075 | |
9076 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists | |
9077 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW | |
9078 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists; | |
9079 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means | |
9080 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and | |
9081 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation. | |
9082 | |
9083 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl', | |
9084 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call | |
9085 to get an error if the file exists at that time. | |
9086 The error reported is `file-already-exists'. | |
9087 | |
9088 ** Function `format' now handles text properties. | |
9089 | |
9090 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string. | |
9091 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties | |
9092 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the | |
9093 result string. | |
9094 | |
9095 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result | |
9096 string where arguments appear in the result string. | |
9097 | |
9098 Example: | |
9099 | |
9100 (let ((s1 "hello, %s") | |
9101 (s2 "world")) | |
9102 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1) | |
9103 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2) | |
9104 (format s1 s2)) | |
9105 | |
9106 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end. | |
9107 | |
9108 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties. | |
9109 | |
9110 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'. | |
9111 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic | |
9112 argument in it. | |
9113 | |
9114 (let ((msg "hello, %s!") | |
9115 (arg "world")) | |
9116 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg) | |
9117 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg) | |
9118 (message msg arg)) | |
9119 | |
9120 ** Sound support | |
9121 | |
9122 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs | |
9123 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver). | |
9124 | |
9125 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio | |
9126 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' | |
9127 to enable sound support. | |
9128 | |
9129 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a | |
9130 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined | |
9131 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The | |
9132 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the | |
9133 sound to play, before playing the sound. | |
9134 | |
9135 The following sound properties are supported: | |
9136 | |
9137 - `:file FILE' | |
9138 | |
9139 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be | |
9140 searched relative to `data-directory'. | |
9141 | |
9142 - `:data DATA' | |
9143 | |
9144 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data | |
9145 may be present, but not both. | |
9146 | |
9147 - `:volume VOLUME' | |
9148 | |
9149 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range | |
9150 0..1. This property is optional. | |
9151 | |
9152 - `:device DEVICE' | |
9153 | |
9154 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the | |
9155 sound. The default device is system-dependent. | |
9156 | |
9157 Other properties are ignored. | |
9158 | |
9159 An alternative interface is called as | |
9160 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE). | |
9161 | |
9162 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group. | |
9163 | |
9164 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being | |
9165 a keyword symbol. | |
9166 | |
9167 ** Changes to garbage collection | |
9168 | |
9169 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number | |
9170 of live and free strings. | |
9171 | |
9172 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of | |
9173 strings that have been consed so far. | |
9174 | |
9175 | |
9176 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs | |
9177 Lisp Manual | |
9178 | |
9179 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes | |
9180 mini-windows. | |
9181 | |
9182 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional | |
9183 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is | |
9184 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil. | |
9185 | |
9186 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used. | |
9187 | |
9188 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text. | |
9189 | |
9190 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an | |
9191 image. | |
9192 | |
9193 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME | |
9194 | |
9195 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT). | |
9196 | |
9197 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes | |
9198 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical | |
9199 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default | |
9200 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. | |
9201 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame. | |
9202 | |
9203 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image | |
9204 has a mask bitmap. | |
9205 | |
9206 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME | |
9207 | |
9208 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap. | |
9209 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil | |
9210 or omitted means use the selected frame. | |
9211 | |
9212 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image | |
9213 satisfying one of a list of specifications. | |
9214 | |
9215 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now | |
9216 optional. | |
9217 | |
9218 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see | |
9219 below). | |
9220 | |
9221 | |
9222 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1 | |
9223 | |
9224 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used | |
9225 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs. | |
9226 | |
9227 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying | |
9228 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground | |
9229 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on | |
9230 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on | |
9231 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to | |
9232 just display it black instead. | |
9233 | |
9234 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put | |
9235 a line like | |
9236 | |
9237 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t) | |
9238 | |
9239 in your `.emacs'. | |
9240 | |
9241 ** New face implementation. | |
9242 | |
9243 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD | |
9244 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected. | |
9245 | |
9246 *** New faces. | |
9247 | |
9248 Each face can specify the following display attributes: | |
9249 | |
9250 1. Font family or fontset alias name. | |
9251 | |
9252 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set | |
9253 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'. | |
9254 | |
9255 3. Font height in 1/10pt | |
9256 | |
9257 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'. | |
9258 | |
9259 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'. | |
9260 | |
9261 6. Foreground color. | |
9262 | |
9263 7. Background color. | |
9264 | |
9265 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color. | |
9266 | |
9267 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video. | |
9268 | |
9269 10. A background stipple, a bitmap. | |
9270 | |
9271 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color. | |
9272 | |
9273 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what | |
9274 color. | |
9275 | |
9276 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its | |
9277 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance. | |
9278 | |
9279 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the | |
9280 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different | |
9281 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named | |
9282 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector | |
9283 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face | |
9284 attributes mentioned above. | |
9285 | |
9286 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face | |
9287 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly | |
9288 created frames. | |
9289 | |
9290 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified | |
9291 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called | |
9292 `fully-specified'. | |
9293 | |
9294 *** Face merging. | |
9295 | |
9296 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by | |
9297 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any | |
9298 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text | |
9299 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure | |
9300 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always | |
9301 results in a fully-specified face. | |
9302 | |
9303 *** Face realization. | |
9304 | |
9305 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by | |
9306 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The | |
9307 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically | |
9308 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized | |
9309 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face | |
9310 cache of the frame on which it was realized. | |
9311 | |
9312 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the | |
9313 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used | |
9314 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different | |
9315 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them. | |
9316 | |
9317 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a | |
9318 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face | |
9319 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of | |
9320 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with | |
9321 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets. | |
9322 | |
9323 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function | |
9324 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those > | |
9325 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from | |
9326 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is | |
9327 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for | |
9328 Emacs. | |
9329 | |
9330 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with | |
9331 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same | |
9332 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent | |
9333 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only. | |
9334 | |
9335 **** Clearing face caches. | |
9336 | |
9337 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches | |
9338 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload | |
9339 unused fonts. | |
9340 | |
9341 *** Font selection. | |
9342 | |
9343 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a | |
9344 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently | |
9345 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name. | |
9346 | |
9347 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a | |
9348 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font | |
9349 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a | |
9350 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to | |
9351 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed. | |
9352 | |
9353 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched | |
9354 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best | |
9355 match for the given face attributes in this font list. | |
9356 | |
9357 Font selection can be influenced by the user. | |
9358 | |
9359 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face | |
9360 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting | |
9361 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute | |
9362 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means | |
9363 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font | |
9364 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries | |
9365 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc. | |
9366 | |
9367 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify | |
9368 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face | |
9369 doesn't exist. | |
9370 | |
9371 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify | |
9372 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a | |
9373 registry. | |
9374 | |
9375 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are | |
9376 slightly different. | |
9377 | |
9378 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts. | |
9379 | |
9380 | |
9381 **** Scalable fonts | |
9382 | |
9383 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default, | |
9384 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86 | |
9385 servers. | |
9386 | |
9387 To enable scalable font use, set the variable | |
9388 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use | |
9389 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used. | |
9390 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A | |
9391 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from | |
9392 that list. Example: | |
9393 | |
9394 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$")) | |
9395 | |
9396 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'. | |
9397 | |
9398 *** Functions and variables related to font selection. | |
9399 | |
9400 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME | |
9401 | |
9402 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY | |
9403 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a | |
9404 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'. | |
9405 | |
9406 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of | |
9407 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P | |
9408 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name. | |
9409 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and | |
9410 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font. | |
9411 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil | |
9412 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and | |
9413 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of | |
9414 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting | |
9415 of the face font sort order. | |
9416 | |
9417 - Function: x-font-family-list | |
9418 | |
9419 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is | |
9420 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses | |
9421 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is | |
9422 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch. | |
9423 | |
9424 - Variable: font-list-limit | |
9425 | |
9426 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions | |
9427 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a | |
9428 matching font. The default is currently 100. | |
9429 | |
9430 *** Setting face attributes. | |
9431 | |
9432 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible | |
9433 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now | |
9434 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and | |
9435 `face-attribute'. | |
9436 | |
9437 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword | |
9438 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'. | |
9439 | |
9440 The following attributes are recognized: | |
9441 | |
9442 `:family' | |
9443 | |
9444 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'', | |
9445 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*' | |
9446 and `?' are allowed. | |
9447 | |
9448 `:width' | |
9449 | |
9450 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use. | |
9451 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed', | |
9452 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded', | |
9453 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'. | |
9454 | |
9455 `:height' | |
9456 | |
9457 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use | |
9458 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to | |
9459 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old | |
9460 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height. | |
9461 | |
9462 `:weight' | |
9463 | |
9464 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the | |
9465 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal', | |
9466 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'. | |
9467 | |
9468 `:slant' | |
9469 | |
9470 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the | |
9471 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or | |
9472 `reverse-oblique'. | |
9473 | |
9474 `:foreground', `:background' | |
9475 | |
9476 VALUE must be a color name, a string. | |
9477 | |
9478 `:underline' | |
9479 | |
9480 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If | |
9481 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is | |
9482 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly | |
9483 don't underline. | |
9484 | |
9485 `:overline' | |
9486 | |
9487 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If | |
9488 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a | |
9489 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't | |
9490 overline. | |
9491 | |
9492 `:strike-through' | |
9493 | |
9494 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line | |
9495 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the | |
9496 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE | |
9497 is nil, explicitly don't strike through. | |
9498 | |
9499 `:box' | |
9500 | |
9501 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn | |
9502 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If | |
9503 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color | |
9504 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name, | |
9505 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise, | |
9506 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH | |
9507 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from | |
9508 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as | |
9509 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it | |
9510 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is | |
9511 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background | |
9512 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box | |
9513 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking | |
9514 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box | |
9515 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if | |
9516 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D | |
9517 box. | |
9518 | |
9519 `:inverse-video' | |
9520 | |
9521 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in | |
9522 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil. | |
9523 | |
9524 `:stipple' | |
9525 | |
9526 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data. | |
9527 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are | |
9528 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH | |
9529 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA | |
9530 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means | |
9531 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern. | |
9532 | |
9533 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight', | |
9534 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name: | |
9535 | |
9536 `:font' | |
9537 | |
9538 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid | |
9539 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font | |
9540 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous | |
9541 versions of Emacs. | |
9542 | |
9543 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can | |
9544 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE | |
9545 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed." | |
9546 | |
9547 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and | |
9548 `defface'. | |
9549 | |
9550 `:inherit' | |
9551 | |
9552 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list | |
9553 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face | |
9554 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces. | |
9555 | |
9556 *** Face attributes and X resources | |
9557 | |
9558 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes | |
9559 from X resources: | |
9560 | |
9561 Face attribute X resource class | |
9562 ----------------------------------------------------------------------- | |
9563 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily | |
9564 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth | |
9565 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight | |
9566 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight | |
9567 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant | |
9568 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground | |
9569 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground | |
9570 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline | |
9571 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough | |
9572 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox | |
9573 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline | |
9574 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse | |
9575 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple | |
9576 or attributeBackgroundPixmap | |
9577 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap | |
9578 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont | |
9579 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold | |
9580 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic | |
9581 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont | |
9582 | |
9583 *** Text property `face'. | |
9584 | |
9585 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face | |
9586 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face | |
9587 specification can be | |
9588 | |
9589 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face. | |
9590 | |
9591 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each | |
9592 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value | |
9593 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute' | |
9594 for face attribute names. | |
9595 | |
9596 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or | |
9597 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is | |
9598 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions. | |
9599 | |
9600 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals. | |
9601 | |
9602 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use | |
9603 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on | |
9604 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by | |
9605 default. You can get defined colors with a call to | |
9606 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be | |
9607 used to clear the mapping table. | |
9608 | |
9609 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type. | |
9610 | |
9611 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values', | |
9612 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose | |
9613 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style | |
9614 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame | |
9615 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the | |
9616 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and | |
9617 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for | |
9618 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs | |
9619 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to | |
9620 modify their color-related behavior. | |
9621 | |
9622 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for | |
9623 any frame type. | |
9624 | |
9625 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities. | |
9626 | |
9627 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p', | |
9628 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens', | |
9629 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width', | |
9630 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under', | |
9631 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and | |
9632 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular | |
9633 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing | |
9634 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling | |
9635 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'. | |
9636 | |
9637 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular | |
9638 display can display image files. | |
9639 | |
9640 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer. | |
9641 | |
9642 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to. | |
9643 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize | |
9644 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the | |
9645 `Inviolable' option. | |
9646 | |
9647 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the | |
9648 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current. | |
9649 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'. | |
9650 | |
9651 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers. | |
9652 | |
9653 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs | |
9654 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field' | |
9655 property (which can be a text property or an overlay). | |
9656 | |
9657 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence, | |
9658 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come | |
9659 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will | |
9660 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement | |
9661 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field | |
9662 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding | |
9663 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these | |
9664 functions. | |
9665 | |
9666 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in | |
9667 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common | |
9668 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt. | |
9669 | |
9670 The following functions are defined for operating on fields: | |
9671 | |
9672 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY | |
9673 | |
9674 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS. | |
9675 | |
9676 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property. | |
9677 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the | |
9678 constrained position if that is different. | |
9679 | |
9680 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable | |
9681 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument | |
9682 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is | |
9683 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property | |
9684 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE | |
9685 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent | |
9686 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with | |
9687 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is | |
9688 also considered to be `on the boundary'. | |
9689 | |
9690 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining | |
9691 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned | |
9692 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like | |
9693 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries | |
9694 only in the case where they can still move to the right line. | |
9695 | |
9696 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has | |
9697 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored. | |
9698 | |
9699 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil. | |
9700 | |
9701 - Function: delete-field &optional POS | |
9702 | |
9703 Delete the field surrounding POS. | |
9704 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property. | |
9705 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS. | |
9706 | |
9707 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE | |
9708 | |
9709 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS. | |
9710 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property. | |
9711 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS. | |
9712 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its | |
9713 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned. | |
9714 | |
9715 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE | |
9716 | |
9717 Return the end of the field surrounding POS. | |
9718 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property. | |
9719 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS. | |
9720 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field, | |
9721 then the end of the *following* field is returned. | |
9722 | |
9723 - Function: field-string &optional POS | |
9724 | |
9725 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string. | |
9726 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property. | |
9727 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS. | |
9728 | |
9729 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS | |
9730 | |
9731 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties. | |
9732 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property. | |
9733 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS. | |
9734 | |
9735 ** Image support. | |
9736 | |
9737 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving | |
9738 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of | |
9739 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value | |
9740 replaces the display of the characters having that property. | |
9741 | |
9742 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of | |
9743 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If | |
9744 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a | |
9745 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal | |
9746 area. | |
9747 | |
9748 IMAGE is an image specification. | |
9749 | |
9750 *** Image specifications | |
9751 | |
9752 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS | |
9753 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each | |
9754 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a | |
9755 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not | |
9756 described below are ignored. | |
9757 | |
9758 The following is a list of properties all image types share. | |
9759 | |
9760 `:ascent ASCENT' | |
9761 | |
9762 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'. | |
9763 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height | |
9764 to use for its ascent. | |
9765 | |
9766 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the | |
9767 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in. | |
9768 | |
9769 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a | |
9770 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position | |
9771 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and | |
9772 overlays that apply to the image. | |
9773 | |
9774 `:margin MARGIN' | |
9775 | |
9776 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put | |
9777 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the | |
9778 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0. | |
9779 | |
9780 `:relief RELIEF' | |
9781 | |
9782 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief | |
9783 around an image. | |
9784 | |
9785 `:conversion ALGO' | |
9786 | |
9787 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it. | |
9788 | |
9789 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss'' | |
9790 edge-detection algorithm to the image. | |
9791 | |
9792 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means | |
9793 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a | |
9794 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at | |
9795 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels | |
9796 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the | |
9797 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the | |
9798 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at | |
9799 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown | |
9800 below. | |
9801 | |
9802 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1 | |
9803 x-1/y x/y x+1/y | |
9804 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1) | |
9805 | |
9806 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color | |
9807 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels, | |
9808 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum | |
9809 of the factors' absolute values. | |
9810 | |
9811 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of | |
9812 | |
9813 (1 0 0 | |
9814 0 0 0 | |
9815 9 9 -1) | |
9816 | |
9817 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of | |
9818 | |
9819 ( 2 -1 0 | |
9820 -1 0 1 | |
9821 0 1 -2) | |
9822 | |
9823 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks | |
9824 ``disabled''. | |
9825 | |
9826 `:mask MASK' | |
9827 | |
9828 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for | |
9829 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the | |
9830 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the | |
9831 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the | |
9832 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is | |
9833 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED | |
9834 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the | |
9835 image. | |
9836 | |
9837 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images | |
9838 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying | |
9839 `:mask nil'. | |
9840 | |
9841 `:file FILE' | |
9842 | |
9843 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it, | |
9844 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support | |
9845 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property | |
9846 may be present in the image specification. | |
9847 | |
9848 `:data DATA' | |
9849 | |
9850 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet | |
9851 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be | |
9852 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types | |
9853 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA. | |
9854 | |
9855 *** Supported image types | |
9856 | |
9857 **** XBM, image type `xbm'. | |
9858 | |
9859 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image | |
9860 properties supported are: | |
9861 | |
9862 `:foreground FG' | |
9863 | |
9864 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil | |
9865 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color. | |
9866 | |
9867 `:background BG' | |
9868 | |
9869 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil | |
9870 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color. | |
9871 | |
9872 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this | |
9873 case, the image specification must contain the following properties | |
9874 instead of a `:file' property. | |
9875 | |
9876 `:width WIDTH' | |
9877 | |
9878 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels. | |
9879 | |
9880 `:height HEIGHT' | |
9881 | |
9882 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels. | |
9883 | |
9884 `:data DATA' | |
9885 | |
9886 DATA must be either | |
9887 | |
9888 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must | |
9889 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT | |
9890 | |
9891 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT | |
9892 | |
9893 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the | |
9894 bitmap. | |
9895 | |
9896 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor | |
9897 height may be specified in this case because these are defined | |
9898 in the file. | |
9899 | |
9900 **** XPM, image type `xpm' | |
9901 | |
9902 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package | |
9903 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is | |
9904 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via | |
9905 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'. | |
9906 | |
9907 Additional image properties supported are: | |
9908 | |
9909 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS' | |
9910 | |
9911 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the | |
9912 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color | |
9913 name. | |
9914 | |
9915 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case, | |
9916 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property. | |
9917 | |
9918 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able | |
9919 to display compressed images. | |
9920 | |
9921 **** PBM, image type `pbm' | |
9922 | |
9923 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and | |
9924 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for | |
9925 mono images are: | |
9926 | |
9927 `:foreground FG' | |
9928 | |
9929 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil | |
9930 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color. | |
9931 | |
9932 `:background FG' | |
9933 | |
9934 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil | |
9935 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color. | |
9936 | |
9937 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg' | |
9938 | |
9939 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg', | |
9940 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image | |
9941 properties defined. | |
9942 | |
9943 **** TIFF, image type `tiff' | |
9944 | |
9945 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff', | |
9946 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image | |
9947 properties defined. | |
9948 | |
9949 **** GIF, image type `gif' | |
9950 | |
9951 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package | |
9952 `libungif-4.1.0', or later. | |
9953 | |
9954 Additional image properties supported are: | |
9955 | |
9956 `:index INDEX' | |
9957 | |
9958 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a | |
9959 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays | |
9960 as a hollow box. | |
9961 | |
9962 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs. | |
9963 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file | |
9964 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images | |
9965 every 0.1 seconds. | |
9966 | |
9967 (defun show-anim (file max) | |
9968 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages." | |
9969 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t)) | |
9970 | |
9971 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time) | |
9972 (when (= idx max) | |
9973 (setq idx 0)) | |
9974 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx))) | |
9975 (save-excursion | |
9976 (set-buffer buffer) | |
9977 (goto-char (point-min)) | |
9978 (unless first-time (delete-char 1)) | |
9979 (insert-image img "x")) | |
9980 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil))) | |
9981 | |
9982 **** PNG, image type `png' | |
9983 | |
9984 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng', | |
9985 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image | |
9986 properties defined. | |
9987 | |
9988 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'. | |
9989 | |
9990 Additional image properties supported are: | |
9991 | |
9992 `:pt-width WIDTH' | |
9993 | |
9994 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an | |
9995 integer. This is a required property. | |
9996 | |
9997 `:pt-height HEIGHT' | |
9998 | |
9999 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT | |
10000 must be a integer. This is an required property. | |
10001 | |
10002 `:bounding-box BOX' | |
10003 | |
10004 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of | |
10005 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS | |
10006 files. This is an required property. | |
10007 | |
10008 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See | |
10009 lisp/gs.el. | |
10010 | |
10011 *** Lisp interface. | |
10012 | |
10013 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types | |
10014 which are supported in the current configuration. | |
10015 | |
10016 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when | |
10017 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds. | |
10018 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache | |
10019 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all | |
10020 images with `equal' specifications share the same image. | |
10021 | |
10022 *** Simplified image API, image.el | |
10023 | |
10024 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image | |
10025 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image' | |
10026 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to | |
10027 define an image based on available image types. The functions | |
10028 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a | |
10029 buffer. | |
10030 | |
10031 ** Display margins. | |
10032 | |
10033 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text | |
10034 and images. | |
10035 | |
10036 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables | |
10037 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call | |
10038 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to | |
10039 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and | |
10040 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying | |
10041 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update | |
10042 of the display margins. | |
10043 | |
10044 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property | |
10045 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is | |
10046 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a | |
10047 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later | |
10048 in this file). | |
10049 | |
10050 ** Help display | |
10051 | |
10052 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse | |
10053 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property | |
10054 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line | |
10055 that have a `help-echo' property. | |
10056 | |
10057 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function | |
10058 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is | |
10059 the window in which the help was found. | |
10060 | |
10061 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the | |
10062 `help-echo' text property was found. | |
10063 | |
10064 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and | |
10065 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse. | |
10066 | |
10067 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with | |
10068 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the | |
10069 mouse. | |
10070 | |
10071 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a | |
10072 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string. | |
10073 | |
10074 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to | |
10075 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a | |
10076 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string. | |
10077 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is | |
10078 used as help string. | |
10079 | |
10080 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays | |
10081 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window | |
10082 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area. | |
10083 | |
10084 ** Vertical fractional scrolling. | |
10085 | |
10086 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels. | |
10087 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible. | |
10088 | |
10089 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical | |
10090 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height. | |
10091 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical | |
10092 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be | |
10093 used. | |
10094 | |
10095 (global-set-key [A-down] | |
10096 #'(lambda () | |
10097 (interactive) | |
10098 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window) | |
10099 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll))))) | |
10100 (global-set-key [A-up] | |
10101 #'(lambda () | |
10102 (interactive) | |
10103 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window) | |
10104 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5))))) | |
10105 | |
10106 ** New hook `fontification-functions'. | |
10107 | |
10108 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay | |
10109 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This | |
10110 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function | |
10111 is called with one argument, POS. | |
10112 | |
10113 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more | |
10114 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them | |
10115 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text | |
10116 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the | |
10117 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to. | |
10118 | |
10119 ** Tool bar support. | |
10120 | |
10121 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame | |
10122 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar") | |
10123 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value | |
10124 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and | |
10125 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed | |
10126 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible. | |
10127 | |
10128 *** Tool bar item definitions | |
10129 | |
10130 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key | |
10131 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)' | |
10132 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'. | |
10133 | |
10134 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is | |
10135 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in | |
10136 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help' | |
10137 property (see below). | |
10138 | |
10139 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as | |
10140 binding are currently ignored. | |
10141 | |
10142 The following properties are recognized: | |
10143 | |
10144 `:enable FORM'. | |
10145 | |
10146 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled | |
10147 or disabled. | |
10148 | |
10149 `:visible FORM' | |
10150 | |
10151 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed. | |
10152 | |
10153 `:filter FUNCTION' | |
10154 | |
10155 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which | |
10156 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is | |
10157 used instead of BINDING to display this item. | |
10158 | |
10159 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)' | |
10160 | |
10161 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated | |
10162 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not. | |
10163 | |
10164 `:image IMAGES' | |
10165 | |
10166 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four | |
10167 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the | |
10168 meaning of each of the four elements: | |
10169 | |
10170 Index Use when item is | |
10171 ---------------------------------------- | |
10172 0 enabled and selected | |
10173 1 enabled and deselected | |
10174 2 disabled and selected | |
10175 3 disabled and deselected | |
10176 | |
10177 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection | |
10178 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state. | |
10179 | |
10180 `:help HELP-STRING'. | |
10181 | |
10182 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help | |
10183 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item. | |
10184 | |
10185 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding | |
10186 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used | |
10187 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the | |
10188 menu bar. | |
10189 | |
10190 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar | |
10191 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set | |
10192 buffer-locally to override the global map. | |
10193 | |
10194 *** Tool-bar-related variables. | |
10195 | |
10196 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically | |
10197 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger | |
10198 than 1/4 of the frame's size. | |
10199 | |
10200 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be | |
10201 raised when the mouse moves over them. | |
10202 | |
10203 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting | |
10204 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of | |
10205 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and | |
10206 vertical margins . Default is 1. | |
10207 | |
10208 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting | |
10209 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3. | |
10210 | |
10211 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers. | |
10212 | |
10213 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on | |
10214 a tool bar item. If | |
10215 | |
10216 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell] | |
10217 '(menu-item "Shell" shell | |
10218 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm"))) | |
10219 | |
10220 is the original tool bar item definition, then | |
10221 | |
10222 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command) | |
10223 | |
10224 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same | |
10225 item. | |
10226 | |
10227 ** Mode line changes. | |
10228 | |
10229 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line. | |
10230 | |
10231 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there | |
10232 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display | |
10233 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line. | |
10234 | |
10235 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has | |
10236 a `local-map' text property. | |
10237 | |
10238 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and | |
10239 that format specifier has a `local-map' property. | |
10240 | |
10241 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM | |
10242 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a | |
10243 `local-map' property. | |
10244 | |
10245 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo' | |
10246 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an | |
10247 example. | |
10248 | |
10249 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is | |
10250 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element. | |
10251 | |
10252 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local | |
10253 variable mode-line-format to nil. | |
10254 | |
10255 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window. | |
10256 | |
10257 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable | |
10258 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are | |
10259 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and | |
10260 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top | |
10261 line. | |
10262 | |
10263 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face | |
10264 `header-line'. | |
10265 | |
10266 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a | |
10267 position in the header-line. | |
10268 | |
10269 ** Text property `display' | |
10270 | |
10271 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text, | |
10272 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is | |
10273 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of | |
10274 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described | |
10275 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications. | |
10276 | |
10277 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas | |
10278 | |
10279 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other | |
10280 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'. | |
10281 | |
10282 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left | |
10283 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in | |
10284 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING | |
10285 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the | |
10286 simpler form STRING as property value. | |
10287 | |
10288 *** Variable width and height spaces | |
10289 | |
10290 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display | |
10291 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is | |
10292 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal | |
10293 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right | |
10294 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is | |
10295 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the | |
10296 simpler form STRETCH as property value. | |
10297 | |
10298 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space | |
10299 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the | |
10300 properties described below. | |
10301 | |
10302 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the | |
10303 characters having the `display' property. | |
10304 | |
10305 - :width WIDTH | |
10306 | |
10307 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal | |
10308 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number. | |
10309 | |
10310 - :relative-width FACTOR | |
10311 | |
10312 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the | |
10313 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the | |
10314 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the | |
10315 width of that character by FACTOR. | |
10316 | |
10317 - :align-to HPOS | |
10318 | |
10319 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The | |
10320 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width. | |
10321 | |
10322 Exactly one of the above properties should be used. | |
10323 | |
10324 - :height HEIGHT | |
10325 | |
10326 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the | |
10327 normal line height. | |
10328 | |
10329 - :relative-height FACTOR | |
10330 | |
10331 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height | |
10332 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR. | |
10333 | |
10334 - :ascent ASCENT | |
10335 | |
10336 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be | |
10337 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the | |
10338 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or | |
10339 equal to 100. | |
10340 | |
10341 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together. | |
10342 | |
10343 *** Images | |
10344 | |
10345 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION | |
10346 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces, | |
10347 in the display, the characters having this display specification in | |
10348 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', | |
10349 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is | |
10350 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal | |
10351 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in | |
10352 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE | |
10353 as display specification. | |
10354 | |
10355 *** Other display properties | |
10356 | |
10357 - (space-width FACTOR) | |
10358 | |
10359 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property | |
10360 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an | |
10361 integer or float. | |
10362 | |
10363 - (height HEIGHT) | |
10364 | |
10365 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger. | |
10366 | |
10367 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that | |
10368 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of | |
10369 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A | |
10370 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which | |
10371 a font is available counts as a step. | |
10372 | |
10373 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times | |
10374 as tall as the frame's default font. | |
10375 | |
10376 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current | |
10377 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use. | |
10378 | |
10379 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol | |
10380 `height' bound to the current specified font height. | |
10381 | |
10382 - (raise FACTOR) | |
10383 | |
10384 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current | |
10385 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters | |
10386 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The | |
10387 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the | |
10388 `height' subproperty. | |
10389 | |
10390 *** Conditional display properties | |
10391 | |
10392 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification | |
10393 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies | |
10394 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the | |
10395 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the | |
10396 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are | |
10397 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where | |
10398 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be | |
10399 different when object is a string. | |
10400 | |
10401 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to | |
10402 `(when t . SPEC)'. | |
10403 | |
10404 ** New menu separator types. | |
10405 | |
10406 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with | |
10407 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are | |
10408 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used | |
10409 to specify other menu separator types. | |
10410 | |
10411 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine' | |
10412 | |
10413 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the | |
10414 separator occurs. | |
10415 | |
10416 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine' | |
10417 | |
10418 A single line in the menu's foreground color. | |
10419 | |
10420 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine' | |
10421 | |
10422 A double line in the menu's foreground color. | |
10423 | |
10424 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine' | |
10425 | |
10426 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color. | |
10427 | |
10428 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine' | |
10429 | |
10430 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color. | |
10431 | |
10432 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn' | |
10433 | |
10434 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form | |
10435 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only. | |
10436 | |
10437 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut' | |
10438 | |
10439 A single line with 3D raised appearance. | |
10440 | |
10441 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash' | |
10442 | |
10443 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance. | |
10444 | |
10445 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash' | |
10446 | |
10447 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance. | |
10448 | |
10449 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn' | |
10450 | |
10451 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance. | |
10452 | |
10453 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut' | |
10454 | |
10455 Two lines with 3D raised appearance. | |
10456 | |
10457 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash' | |
10458 | |
10459 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance. | |
10460 | |
10461 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash' | |
10462 | |
10463 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance. | |
10464 | |
10465 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like | |
10466 the corresponding single-line separators. | |
10467 | |
10468 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors. | |
10469 | |
10470 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and | |
10471 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors. | |
10472 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify | |
10473 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars, | |
10474 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the | |
10475 default background is the background color of the frame, and the | |
10476 default foreground is black. | |
10477 | |
10478 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground' | |
10479 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class | |
10480 `ScrollBarBackground'). | |
10481 | |
10482 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource | |
10483 settings for scroll bar colors. | |
10484 | |
10485 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent | |
10486 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending. | |
10487 | |
10488 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it | |
10489 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based | |
10490 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued | |
10491 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from | |
10492 the original window start. | |
10493 | |
10494 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions | |
10495 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed | |
10496 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented. | |
10497 | |
10498 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height. | |
10499 | |
10500 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable | |
10501 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes | |
10502 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any | |
10503 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height. | |
10504 | |
10505 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer | |
10506 fixed-width and fixed-height. | |
10507 | |
10508 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t) | |
10509 | |
10510 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is | |
10511 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the | |
10512 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To | |
10513 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed' | |
10514 temporarily to nil, for example | |
10515 | |
10516 (let ((window-size-fixed nil)) | |
10517 (enlarge-window 10)) | |
10518 | |
10519 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically, | |
10520 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error. | |
10521 | |
10522 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS | |
10523 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape | |
10524 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter | |
10525 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is | |
10526 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't | |
10527 support a vertical-bar cursor). | |
10528 | |
10529 | |
10530 | |
10531 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes | |
10532 | |
10533 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard | |
10534 input. | |
10535 | |
10536 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos. | |
10537 | |
10538 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages. | |
10539 | |
10540 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not | |
10541 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The | |
10542 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets | |
10543 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence | |
10544 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search. | |
10545 | |
10546 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has | |
10547 been added. | |
10548 | |
10549 | |
10550 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change | |
10551 | |
10552 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added. | |
10553 | |
10554 | |
10555 | |
10556 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes. | |
10557 | |
10558 ** Not new, but not mentioned before: | |
10559 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark. | |
10560 | |
10561 * Changes in Emacs 20.4 | |
10562 | |
10563 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el. | |
10564 | |
10565 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'. | |
10566 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name | |
10567 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way. | |
10568 | |
10569 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file | |
10570 is the one that is used. | |
10571 | |
10572 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return | |
10573 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous). | |
10574 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output, | |
10575 separate from the command's regular output. | |
10576 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer | |
10577 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name. | |
10578 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies | |
10579 the buffer name. | |
10580 | |
10581 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error | |
10582 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate | |
10583 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not | |
10584 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there. | |
10585 | |
10586 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in | |
10587 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom, | |
10588 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers | |
10589 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs. | |
10590 | |
10591 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For | |
10592 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names | |
10593 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the | |
10594 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name. | |
10595 | |
10596 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches | |
10597 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace: | |
10598 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then | |
10599 they never ignore case. | |
10600 | |
10601 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned | |
10602 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually | |
10603 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents | |
10604 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or | |
10605 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs | |
10606 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a | |
10607 part of the general feature of coding system conversion. | |
10608 | |
10609 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to | |
10610 the same format that was used in the file before. | |
10611 | |
10612 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable | |
10613 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group. | |
10614 | |
10615 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been | |
10616 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling. | |
10617 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected. | |
10618 | |
10619 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed. | |
10620 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a | |
10621 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for | |
10622 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format | |
10623 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual | |
10624 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for | |
10625 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac). | |
10626 | |
10627 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos, | |
10628 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings, | |
10629 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line | |
10630 format. You can now customize these variables. | |
10631 | |
10632 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a | |
10633 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a | |
10634 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of | |
10635 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil. | |
10636 | |
10637 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode | |
10638 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given | |
10639 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents. | |
10640 | |
10641 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function | |
10642 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file | |
10643 doesn't have any effect. | |
10644 | |
10645 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process, | |
10646 not one per buffer. | |
10647 | |
10648 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to | |
10649 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line: | |
10650 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup) | |
10651 | |
10652 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el. | |
10653 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the | |
10654 `auto-show-mode' command. | |
10655 | |
10656 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to | |
10657 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous | |
10658 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font | |
10659 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change | |
10660 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then. | |
10661 | |
10662 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's | |
10663 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel. | |
10664 | |
10665 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the | |
10666 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this | |
10667 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil. | |
10668 | |
10669 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at | |
10670 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an | |
10671 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode | |
10672 and variable specification, as well as on the first line. | |
10673 | |
10674 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters. | |
10675 | |
10676 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system | |
10677 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and | |
10678 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that | |
10679 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character | |
10680 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc. | |
10681 | |
10682 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates | |
10683 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported. | |
10684 | |
10685 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have | |
10686 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to | |
10687 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to | |
10688 `?' on other systems. | |
10689 | |
10690 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this | |
10691 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on | |
10692 Unix. | |
10693 | |
10694 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the | |
10695 current codepage when it starts. | |
10696 | |
10697 ** Mail changes | |
10698 | |
10699 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if | |
10700 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime', | |
10701 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if | |
10702 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other | |
10703 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three | |
10704 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is | |
10705 latin-1: | |
10706 | |
10707 MIME-version: 1.0 | |
10708 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1 | |
10709 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit | |
10710 | |
10711 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the | |
10712 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than | |
10713 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than | |
10714 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of | |
10715 buffer-file-coding-system. | |
10716 | |
10717 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set | |
10718 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing | |
10719 mail. | |
10720 | |
10721 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters, | |
10722 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them, | |
10723 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a | |
10724 list of possible coding systems. | |
10725 | |
10726 ** CC Mode changes | |
10727 | |
10728 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major | |
10729 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no | |
10730 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's | |
10731 docstring for details. | |
10732 | |
10733 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic | |
10734 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is | |
10735 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a | |
10736 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied | |
10737 lineup functions use this feature currently. | |
10738 | |
10739 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and | |
10740 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java. | |
10741 | |
10742 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for | |
10743 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines. | |
10744 | |
10745 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately | |
10746 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new | |
10747 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on | |
10748 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for | |
10749 anonymous classes. | |
10750 | |
10751 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific | |
10752 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont | |
10753 | |
10754 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol | |
10755 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike | |
10756 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup | |
10757 function c-lineup-inexpr-block. | |
10758 | |
10759 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists | |
10760 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open | |
10761 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's. | |
10762 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces | |
10763 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified). | |
10764 | |
10765 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default. | |
10766 | |
10767 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line. | |
10768 | |
10769 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren) | |
10770 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed. | |
10771 | |
10772 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero. | |
10773 | |
10774 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation | |
10775 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace. | |
10776 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some | |
10777 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the | |
10778 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that). | |
10779 | |
10780 ** Gnus changes. | |
10781 | |
10782 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been | |
10783 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the | |
10784 Gnus manual for the full story. | |
10785 | |
10786 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than | |
10787 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft | |
10788 group, which is created automatically. | |
10789 | |
10790 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header | |
10791 values. | |
10792 | |
10793 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's. | |
10794 | |
10795 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message | |
10796 outside the region: `C-c C-v'. | |
10797 | |
10798 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with | |
10799 `C-u C-c C-c'. | |
10800 | |
10801 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization. | |
10802 | |
10803 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit | |
10804 re-highlighting of the article buffer. | |
10805 | |
10806 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'. | |
10807 | |
10808 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic | |
10809 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details. | |
10810 | |
10811 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix | |
10812 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file. | |
10813 | |
10814 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater | |
10815 control over simplification. | |
10816 | |
10817 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread. | |
10818 | |
10819 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the | |
10820 limit. | |
10821 | |
10822 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text. | |
10823 | |
10824 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'. | |
10825 | |
10826 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed. | |
10827 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must | |
10828 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead. | |
10829 | |
10830 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix | |
10831 `a' forces normal posting method. | |
10832 | |
10833 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text | |
10834 -- `W d'. | |
10835 | |
10836 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands' | |
10837 to a non-nil value. | |
10838 | |
10839 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling | |
10840 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers. | |
10841 | |
10842 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer | |
10843 has been added. | |
10844 | |
10845 *** A history of where mails have been split is available. | |
10846 | |
10847 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'. | |
10848 | |
10849 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting | |
10850 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'. | |
10851 | |
10852 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added -- | |
10853 `message-cite-original-without-signature'. | |
10854 | |
10855 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command. | |
10856 | |
10857 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has | |
10858 been added. | |
10859 | |
10860 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the | |
10861 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable. | |
10862 | |
10863 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually | |
10864 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command. | |
10865 | |
10866 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend. | |
10867 | |
10868 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb. | |
10869 | |
10870 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated. | |
10871 | |
10872 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode | |
10873 | |
10874 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give | |
10875 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in | |
10876 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "". | |
10877 | |
10878 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a | |
10879 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some | |
10880 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run | |
10881 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you | |
10882 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET. | |
10883 | |
10884 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'. | |
10885 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available | |
10886 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use | |
10887 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell. | |
10888 | |
10889 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check | |
10890 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur* | |
10891 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular | |
10892 mismatch. | |
10893 | |
10894 ** Changes to RefTeX mode | |
10895 | |
10896 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and | |
10897 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys. | |
10898 | |
10899 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now | |
10900 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1 | |
10901 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be | |
10902 removed from the label. | |
10903 | |
10904 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use | |
10905 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'. | |
10906 | |
10907 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the | |
10908 customization group `reftex-finding-files'. | |
10909 | |
10910 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to | |
10911 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular | |
10912 expressions. | |
10913 | |
10914 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers. | |
10915 | |
10916 ** New/deleted modes and packages | |
10917 | |
10918 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and | |
10919 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'. | |
10920 | |
10921 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for | |
10922 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with | |
10923 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'. | |
10924 | |
10925 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and | |
10926 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use | |
10927 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el. | |
10928 | |
10929 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4 | |
10930 | |
10931 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better. | |
10932 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets, | |
10933 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters, | |
10934 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details, | |
10935 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual. | |
10936 | |
10937 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds | |
10938 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim | |
10939 distribution when the config.bat script is run. | |
10940 | |
10941 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on | |
10942 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it | |
10943 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written | |
10944 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of | |
10945 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing | |
10946 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a | |
10947 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external | |
10948 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of | |
10949 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.) | |
10950 | |
10951 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript | |
10952 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs | |
10953 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard | |
10954 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a | |
10955 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external | |
10956 program. | |
10957 | |
10958 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT, | |
10959 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these | |
10960 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax | |
10961 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name | |
10962 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is | |
10963 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches. | |
10964 | |
10965 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has | |
10966 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on | |
10967 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but | |
10968 was not documented clearly before. | |
10969 | |
10970 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals. | |
10971 This includes Tetris and Snake. | |
10972 | |
10973 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4 | |
10974 | |
10975 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position | |
10976 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line. | |
10977 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same | |
10978 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line. | |
10979 | |
10980 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument | |
10981 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing, | |
10982 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern. | |
10983 | |
10984 ** Changes in the file-attributes function. | |
10985 | |
10986 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float. | |
10987 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise. | |
10988 | |
10989 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if | |
10990 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two | |
10991 integers. | |
10992 | |
10993 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of | |
10994 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same | |
10995 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that | |
10996 file names and attributes are returned. | |
10997 | |
10998 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for | |
10999 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It | |
11000 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes. | |
11001 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and | |
11002 returns the result. | |
11003 | |
11004 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern | |
11005 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern. | |
11006 | |
11007 ** New functions for base64 conversion: | |
11008 | |
11009 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer | |
11010 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region | |
11011 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported | |
11012 optionally. | |
11013 | |
11014 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar | |
11015 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string. | |
11016 | |
11017 ** | |
11018 The new function process-running-child-p | |
11019 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its | |
11020 terminal to its own child process. | |
11021 | |
11022 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature: | |
11023 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal | |
11024 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell | |
11025 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent. | |
11026 | |
11027 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can | |
11028 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists. | |
11029 | |
11030 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'. | |
11031 :included is an alias for :visible. | |
11032 | |
11033 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by | |
11034 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used | |
11035 to move or copy menu entries. | |
11036 | |
11037 ** Multibyte editing changes | |
11038 | |
11039 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is | |
11040 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to | |
11041 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also | |
11042 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and | |
11043 char-bytes in a loop typically as below: | |
11044 (setq char (sref str idx) | |
11045 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx))) | |
11046 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete. | |
11047 | |
11048 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character | |
11049 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code: | |
11050 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch)) | |
11051 | |
11052 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the | |
11053 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or | |
11054 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error: | |
11055 | |
11056 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited | |
11057 | |
11058 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character | |
11059 across the boundary. | |
11060 | |
11061 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include | |
11062 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases: | |
11063 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and | |
11064 contains 8-bit characters. | |
11065 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and | |
11066 contains invalid characters. | |
11067 | |
11068 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove | |
11069 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly | |
11070 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing | |
11071 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct | |
11072 way. | |
11073 | |
11074 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems. | |
11075 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of | |
11076 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by | |
11077 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line. | |
11078 | |
11079 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly | |
11080 compose Thai characters in a string. | |
11081 | |
11082 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third | |
11083 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name | |
11084 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as | |
11085 menus should always use the third argument. | |
11086 | |
11087 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char, | |
11088 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second | |
11089 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current | |
11090 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil. | |
11091 | |
11092 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents | |
11093 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in | |
11094 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing | |
11095 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases. | |
11096 | |
11097 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in | |
11098 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it | |
11099 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous | |
11100 echo area contents. | |
11101 | |
11102 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY) | |
11103 | |
11104 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument | |
11105 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the | |
11106 requested feature cannot be loaded. | |
11107 | |
11108 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the | |
11109 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern | |
11110 means to clear out that attribute. | |
11111 | |
11112 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame | |
11113 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame. | |
11114 | |
11115 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now | |
11116 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode | |
11117 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the | |
11118 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer. | |
11119 | |
11120 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on | |
11121 the gap of the current buffer. | |
11122 | |
11123 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way | |
11124 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the | |
11125 current buffer. | |
11126 | |
11127 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to | |
11128 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs. | |
11129 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check | |
11130 it back in after any modifications have been made. | |
11131 | |
11132 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3 | |
11133 | |
11134 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of | |
11135 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and | |
11136 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those | |
11137 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and | |
11138 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path. | |
11139 | |
11140 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose | |
11141 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded. | |
11142 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory | |
11143 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use | |
11144 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched. | |
11145 | |
11146 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it | |
11147 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each | |
11148 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower. | |
11149 | |
11150 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs | |
11151 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically | |
11152 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the | |
11153 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a | |
11154 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired | |
11155 results. | |
11156 | |
11157 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from | |
11158 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers | |
11159 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in | |
11160 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago. | |
11161 | |
11162 * Changes in Emacs 20.3 | |
11163 | |
11164 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command | |
11165 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward, | |
11166 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can | |
11167 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition. | |
11168 | |
11169 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a | |
11170 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired | |
11171 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing | |
11172 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo | |
11173 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made | |
11174 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them | |
11175 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that | |
11176 region. | |
11177 | |
11178 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests | |
11179 selective undo. | |
11180 | |
11181 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are | |
11182 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte | |
11183 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same | |
11184 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs | |
11185 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode. | |
11186 | |
11187 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files, | |
11188 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use | |
11189 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to | |
11190 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started. | |
11191 | |
11192 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and | |
11193 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the | |
11194 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is | |
11195 something that most users not do. | |
11196 | |
11197 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste | |
11198 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X. | |
11199 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other | |
11200 applications. | |
11201 | |
11202 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and | |
11203 pasting operations. | |
11204 | |
11205 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by | |
11206 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks | |
11207 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different | |
11208 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting | |
11209 `ps-printer-name'. | |
11210 | |
11211 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a | |
11212 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember | |
11213 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it | |
11214 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting | |
11215 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor | |
11216 hits a new word. | |
11217 | |
11218 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for | |
11219 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not | |
11220 to be confused by TeX commands. | |
11221 | |
11222 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something | |
11223 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by | |
11224 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu | |
11225 of various alternative replacements and actions. | |
11226 | |
11227 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces | |
11228 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several | |
11229 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in | |
11230 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if | |
11231 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil. | |
11232 | |
11233 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if | |
11234 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil. | |
11235 | |
11236 ** Changes in input method usage. | |
11237 | |
11238 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among | |
11239 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p | |
11240 respectively. | |
11241 | |
11242 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion. | |
11243 | |
11244 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one | |
11245 of the alternatives with Mouse-2. | |
11246 | |
11247 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so | |
11248 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'. | |
11249 | |
11250 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given. | |
11251 | |
11252 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given. | |
11253 | |
11254 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only | |
11255 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py. | |
11256 | |
11257 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is | |
11258 given in the following case: | |
11259 o When you are using a complex input method. | |
11260 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer. | |
11261 | |
11262 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting | |
11263 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice, | |
11264 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with, | |
11265 setting it to t is helpful. | |
11266 | |
11267 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method. | |
11268 | |
11269 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following | |
11270 keys: | |
11271 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method | |
11272 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc | |
11273 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja | |
11274 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language | |
11275 environment. | |
11276 | |
11277 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file | |
11278 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the | |
11279 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to | |
11280 get | |
11281 | |
11282 /usr/foo//etc/passwd | |
11283 | |
11284 which stands for the file /etc/passwd. | |
11285 | |
11286 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list. | |
11287 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list. | |
11288 | |
11289 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t | |
11290 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve | |
11291 its owner and group. | |
11292 | |
11293 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs | |
11294 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries. | |
11295 | |
11296 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle | |
11297 contents before inserting the specified string on each line. | |
11298 | |
11299 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle | |
11300 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column | |
11301 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified | |
11302 by the left edge of the rectangle. | |
11303 | |
11304 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG, | |
11305 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit | |
11306 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful | |
11307 for writing keyboard macros. | |
11308 | |
11309 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories, | |
11310 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The | |
11311 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as | |
11312 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define | |
11313 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and | |
11314 info. | |
11315 | |
11316 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%. | |
11317 | |
11318 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x | |
11319 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region | |
11320 contents only. | |
11321 | |
11322 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for | |
11323 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call | |
11324 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM | |
11325 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case. | |
11326 | |
11327 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited | |
11328 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file | |
11329 literally. If you say no, it signals an error. | |
11330 | |
11331 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature | |
11332 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook. | |
11333 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is | |
11334 inconsistent with Emacs conventions. | |
11335 | |
11336 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or | |
11337 failure if the command produces no output. | |
11338 | |
11339 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window | |
11340 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move | |
11341 the mouse. | |
11342 | |
11343 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to | |
11344 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related | |
11345 function and variable names. | |
11346 | |
11347 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for | |
11348 reading specific files. This has higher priority than | |
11349 file-coding-system-alist. | |
11350 | |
11351 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to | |
11352 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by | |
11353 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to | |
11354 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed | |
11355 according to the current fontset. | |
11356 | |
11357 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed. | |
11358 | |
11359 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of | |
11360 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and | |
11361 nonascii-insert-offset. | |
11362 | |
11363 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if | |
11364 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table | |
11365 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte | |
11366 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters. | |
11367 | |
11368 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get | |
11369 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning. | |
11370 | |
11371 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case | |
11372 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search. | |
11373 | |
11374 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables | |
11375 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant | |
11376 command keys. | |
11377 | |
11378 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for | |
11379 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions. | |
11380 | |
11381 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for | |
11382 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at | |
11383 all variables that have documentation. | |
11384 | |
11385 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer | |
11386 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way | |
11387 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable | |
11388 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap | |
11389 it should show; the default is 20. | |
11390 | |
11391 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode, | |
11392 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole | |
11393 of your input. | |
11394 | |
11395 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize | |
11396 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in | |
11397 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as | |
11398 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all | |
11399 the customizable options which were changed since that version. | |
11400 Newly added options are included as well. | |
11401 | |
11402 If you don't specify a particular version number argument, | |
11403 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options | |
11404 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded. | |
11405 | |
11406 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the | |
11407 Customize menu. | |
11408 | |
11409 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out | |
11410 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command. | |
11411 | |
11412 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of | |
11413 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were | |
11414 invoked. | |
11415 | |
11416 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces | |
11417 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment. | |
11418 The default is 1. | |
11419 | |
11420 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol | |
11421 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has | |
11422 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram | |
11423 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block | |
11424 sensibly. | |
11425 | |
11426 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger. | |
11427 | |
11428 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil | |
11429 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make | |
11430 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them. | |
11431 | |
11432 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a | |
11433 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string | |
11434 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically | |
11435 every night. | |
11436 | |
11437 ** Desktop changes | |
11438 | |
11439 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set | |
11440 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom. | |
11441 | |
11442 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored | |
11443 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'. | |
11444 | |
11445 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to | |
11446 read and post multi-lingual articles. | |
11447 | |
11448 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when | |
11449 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should | |
11450 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden | |
11451 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and | |
11452 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is | |
11453 made invisible again. | |
11454 | |
11455 ** Mail reading and sending changes | |
11456 | |
11457 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of | |
11458 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any | |
11459 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently | |
11460 toggle. | |
11461 | |
11462 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file, | |
11463 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the | |
11464 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if | |
11465 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable | |
11466 rmail-default-body-file. | |
11467 | |
11468 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no | |
11469 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they | |
11470 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use. | |
11471 | |
11472 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string, | |
11473 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression | |
11474 is evaluated to insert the signature. | |
11475 | |
11476 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of | |
11477 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email | |
11478 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for | |
11479 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for | |
11480 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be | |
11481 especially interested in trying feedmail. | |
11482 | |
11483 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of | |
11484 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features | |
11485 provided by feedmail are: | |
11486 | |
11487 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and | |
11488 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users); | |
11489 there is also a queue for draft messages | |
11490 | |
11491 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and | |
11492 be prompted for confirmation | |
11493 | |
11494 **** does smart filling of address headers | |
11495 | |
11496 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be | |
11497 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this | |
11498 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get | |
11499 | |
11500 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting | |
11501 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail, | |
11502 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new | |
11503 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code). | |
11504 | |
11505 ** Dired changes | |
11506 | |
11507 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked | |
11508 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T". | |
11509 | |
11510 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily | |
11511 run Dired on the directory name at point. | |
11512 | |
11513 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of | |
11514 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match | |
11515 for a specified regexp. | |
11516 | |
11517 ** VC Changes | |
11518 | |
11519 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control | |
11520 conveniently. | |
11521 | |
11522 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much | |
11523 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary | |
11524 Dired. | |
11525 | |
11526 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the | |
11527 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive | |
11528 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are | |
11529 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown). | |
11530 | |
11531 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil, | |
11532 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set | |
11533 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version | |
11534 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i' | |
11535 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired. | |
11536 | |
11537 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which | |
11538 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type | |
11539 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on | |
11540 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes | |
11541 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked. | |
11542 | |
11543 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to | |
11544 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all | |
11545 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command, | |
11546 `* l', to mark all files currently locked. | |
11547 | |
11548 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in | |
11549 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls | |
11550 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output. | |
11551 | |
11552 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working | |
11553 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff | |
11554 session to resolve them. | |
11555 | |
11556 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to | |
11557 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that | |
11558 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS | |
11559 uses as well). | |
11560 | |
11561 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new | |
11562 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When | |
11563 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify | |
11564 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that | |
11565 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file. | |
11566 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively, | |
11567 using ediff. | |
11568 | |
11569 ** Changes in Font Lock | |
11570 | |
11571 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face | |
11572 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical | |
11573 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are | |
11574 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for | |
11575 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face. | |
11576 | |
11577 ** Frame name display changes | |
11578 | |
11579 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current | |
11580 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and | |
11581 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or | |
11582 when many frames are invisible or iconified. | |
11583 | |
11584 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the | |
11585 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames | |
11586 menu. | |
11587 | |
11588 ** Comint (subshell) changes | |
11589 | |
11590 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a | |
11591 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility | |
11592 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this. | |
11593 | |
11594 *** There are new commands in Comint mode. | |
11595 | |
11596 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history; | |
11597 that is, the line after the last line you got. | |
11598 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one. | |
11599 | |
11600 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to | |
11601 send the current line together with the following line, when you send | |
11602 the following line. | |
11603 | |
11604 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark, | |
11605 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the | |
11606 previously sent input. | |
11607 | |
11608 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input; | |
11609 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input | |
11610 as the search string. | |
11611 | |
11612 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll | |
11613 automatically in compilation-mode windows. | |
11614 | |
11615 ** C mode changes | |
11616 | |
11617 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation, | |
11618 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is | |
11619 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro | |
11620 definition. | |
11621 | |
11622 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified | |
11623 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations. | |
11624 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu" | |
11625 style is still the default however. | |
11626 | |
11627 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style. | |
11628 | |
11629 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which | |
11630 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer | |
11631 them. They do not have key bindings by default. | |
11632 | |
11633 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) | |
11634 and M-e (c-end-of-statement). | |
11635 | |
11636 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols | |
11637 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace. | |
11638 | |
11639 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets | |
11640 makes the style variables local to that buffer only. | |
11641 | |
11642 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren, | |
11643 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change. | |
11644 | |
11645 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You | |
11646 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire | |
11647 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new | |
11648 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default. | |
11649 | |
11650 ** Changes to hippie-expand. | |
11651 | |
11652 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If | |
11653 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for, | |
11654 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'. | |
11655 | |
11656 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If | |
11657 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when | |
11658 expanding dynamically. | |
11659 | |
11660 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If | |
11661 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched. | |
11662 | |
11663 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If | |
11664 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in | |
11665 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose | |
11666 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'. | |
11667 | |
11668 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied. | |
11669 | |
11670 ** Changes in BibTeX mode. | |
11671 | |
11672 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable | |
11673 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during | |
11674 automatic key generation. This replaces variable | |
11675 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches | |
11676 against the first word in the title. | |
11677 | |
11678 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just | |
11679 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations, | |
11680 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with | |
11681 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use | |
11682 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the | |
11683 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting. | |
11684 | |
11685 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key | |
11686 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is | |
11687 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and | |
11688 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert. | |
11689 | |
11690 ** Changes in vcursor.el. | |
11691 | |
11692 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap | |
11693 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A | |
11694 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be | |
11695 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including | |
11696 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency | |
11697 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps. | |
11698 | |
11699 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the | |
11700 Editing group once the package is loaded. | |
11701 | |
11702 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is | |
11703 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set | |
11704 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior. | |
11705 | |
11706 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the | |
11707 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command. | |
11708 | |
11709 ** Ispell changes. | |
11710 | |
11711 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current | |
11712 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings | |
11713 are identified by syntax tables in effect. | |
11714 | |
11715 *** Generic region skipping implemented. | |
11716 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will | |
11717 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user | |
11718 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this | |
11719 include: | |
11720 | |
11721 o URLs are automatically skipped | |
11722 o EMail message checking is vastly improved. | |
11723 | |
11724 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals. | |
11725 | |
11726 ** Changes to RefTeX mode | |
11727 | |
11728 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very | |
11729 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been | |
11730 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the | |
11731 section `Optimizations' in the manual. | |
11732 | |
11733 *** New recursive parser. | |
11734 | |
11735 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the | |
11736 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new | |
11737 recursive parser scans the individual files. | |
11738 | |
11739 *** Parsing only part of a document. | |
11740 | |
11741 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling | |
11742 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of | |
11743 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t. | |
11744 | |
11745 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t) | |
11746 | |
11747 *** Storing parsing information in a file. | |
11748 | |
11749 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use | |
11750 | |
11751 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t) | |
11752 | |
11753 *** Using multiple selection buffers | |
11754 | |
11755 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens | |
11756 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting | |
11757 | |
11758 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t) | |
11759 | |
11760 *** References to external documents. | |
11761 | |
11762 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external | |
11763 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external | |
11764 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument | |
11765 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with | |
11766 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in | |
11767 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )'). | |
11768 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer. | |
11769 | |
11770 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default. | |
11771 | |
11772 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands, | |
11773 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution. | |
11774 | |
11775 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes | |
11776 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly. | |
11777 | |
11778 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers | |
11779 | |
11780 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc* | |
11781 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'. | |
11782 | |
11783 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes. | |
11784 | |
11785 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of | |
11786 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map', | |
11787 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes | |
11788 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you | |
11789 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?' | |
11790 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out | |
11791 more. | |
11792 | |
11793 *** Support for the varioref package | |
11794 | |
11795 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref. | |
11796 | |
11797 *** New hooks | |
11798 | |
11799 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references, | |
11800 and citations are created. These hooks are | |
11801 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function', | |
11802 `reftex-format-cite-function'. | |
11803 | |
11804 *** Citations outside LaTeX | |
11805 | |
11806 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in | |
11807 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details. | |
11808 | |
11809 *** Short context is no longer fontified. | |
11810 | |
11811 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the | |
11812 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be | |
11813 fontified, use | |
11814 | |
11815 (setq reftex-refontify-context t) | |
11816 | |
11817 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument. | |
11818 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of | |
11819 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other | |
11820 directories that contain the same file name. | |
11821 | |
11822 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file | |
11823 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary | |
11824 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to | |
11825 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that | |
11826 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer | |
11827 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other | |
11828 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present | |
11829 directory. | |
11830 | |
11831 ** New modes and packages | |
11832 | |
11833 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode. | |
11834 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer | |
11835 it, but some do not. | |
11836 | |
11837 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL | |
11838 code. | |
11839 | |
11840 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the | |
11841 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move | |
11842 around in a buffer. | |
11843 | |
11844 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu. | |
11845 | |
11846 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author | |
11847 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should | |
11848 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an | |
11849 established system of notation similar to Chess. | |
11850 | |
11851 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp | |
11852 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style | |
11853 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual. | |
11854 | |
11855 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features | |
11856 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around | |
11857 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc.); others are implementations of | |
11858 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also | |
11859 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and | |
11860 the like. | |
11861 | |
11862 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to | |
11863 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text. | |
11864 | |
11865 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done | |
11866 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not | |
11867 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize | |
11868 the user option `midnight-mode' to t. | |
11869 | |
11870 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes. | |
11871 | |
11872 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files | |
11873 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files | |
11874 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files | |
11875 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files | |
11876 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc.) | |
11877 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files | |
11878 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files | |
11879 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files | |
11880 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files | |
11881 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files | |
11882 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files | |
11883 | |
11884 Platform-specific modes: | |
11885 | |
11886 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files | |
11887 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files | |
11888 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files | |
11889 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files | |
11890 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files | |
11891 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files | |
11892 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts | |
11893 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files | |
11894 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts | |
11895 | |
11896 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published | |
11897 | |
11898 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, | |
11899 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. | |
11900 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode. | |
11901 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode. | |
11902 | |
11903 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether | |
11904 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives | |
11905 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started. | |
11906 | |
11907 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist, | |
11908 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can | |
11909 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for | |
11910 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions. | |
11911 | |
11912 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and | |
11913 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte | |
11914 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language | |
11915 environment. | |
11916 | |
11917 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now | |
11918 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt | |
11919 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the | |
11920 current input method for reading this one event. | |
11921 | |
11922 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte | |
11923 now control whether to output certain characters as | |
11924 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte | |
11925 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte | |
11926 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing | |
11927 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not). | |
11928 | |
11929 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published | |
11930 | |
11931 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version | |
11932 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3. | |
11933 | |
11934 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were | |
11935 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1) | |
11936 always increases point by 1. | |
11937 | |
11938 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is | |
11939 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted. | |
11940 | |
11941 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters. | |
11942 | |
11943 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'. | |
11944 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's | |
11945 default value changed. For example, | |
11946 | |
11947 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed." | |
11948 :type 'integer | |
11949 :group 'foo | |
11950 :version "20.3") | |
11951 | |
11952 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group." | |
11953 :version "20.3") | |
11954 | |
11955 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the | |
11956 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It | |
11957 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a | |
11958 `:version' in the top level group. | |
11959 | |
11960 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command. | |
11961 | |
11962 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name | |
11963 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray. | |
11964 | |
11965 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that | |
11966 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that | |
11967 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables | |
11968 to themselves. | |
11969 | |
11970 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil, | |
11971 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any | |
11972 values whatever. | |
11973 | |
11974 ** There is a new debugger command, R. | |
11975 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result | |
11976 in the buffer *Debugger-record*. | |
11977 | |
11978 ** Frame-local variables. | |
11979 | |
11980 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call | |
11981 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have | |
11982 local bindings for that variable. | |
11983 | |
11984 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a | |
11985 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling | |
11986 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the | |
11987 parameter name. | |
11988 | |
11989 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings. | |
11990 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is | |
11991 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding, | |
11992 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active. | |
11993 | |
11994 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not | |
11995 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a | |
11996 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect | |
11997 through a window-local binding would not be very robust. | |
11998 | |
11999 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing | |
12000 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when | |
12001 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form | |
12002 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns. | |
12003 See the documentation in sregex.el. | |
12004 | |
12005 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which | |
12006 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to | |
12007 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended. | |
12008 The contents of this field are not yet finalized. | |
12009 | |
12010 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION. | |
12011 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'. | |
12012 | |
12013 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from | |
12014 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can | |
12015 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead. | |
12016 | |
12017 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE | |
12018 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as | |
12019 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the | |
12020 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default. | |
12021 | |
12022 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to | |
12023 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters | |
12024 empty input. | |
12025 | |
12026 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use | |
12027 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to | |
12028 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names. | |
12029 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as | |
12030 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string. | |
12031 | |
12032 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal, | |
12033 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments: | |
12034 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a | |
12035 default password to use if the user enters nothing. | |
12036 | |
12037 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to | |
12038 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a | |
12039 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the | |
12040 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns | |
12041 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there. | |
12042 | |
12043 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE. | |
12044 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate | |
12045 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the | |
12046 end of the window, even if this requires computation. | |
12047 | |
12048 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME | |
12049 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use. | |
12050 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list. | |
12051 | |
12052 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer, | |
12053 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window | |
12054 was directed to display this buffer. | |
12055 | |
12056 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects | |
12057 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they | |
12058 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in | |
12059 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to | |
12060 set-window-configuration. | |
12061 | |
12062 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two | |
12063 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer | |
12064 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of | |
12065 windows and the choice of buffers to display. | |
12066 | |
12067 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to | |
12068 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist | |
12069 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP). | |
12070 | |
12071 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a | |
12072 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the | |
12073 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist. | |
12074 | |
12075 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers, | |
12076 and it is meant to be set by major modes. | |
12077 | |
12078 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string | |
12079 except that it discards all text properties from the result. | |
12080 | |
12081 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument | |
12082 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as | |
12083 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100. | |
12084 | |
12085 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory | |
12086 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined | |
12087 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems | |
12088 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables. | |
12089 | |
12090 ** Menu changes | |
12091 | |
12092 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the | |
12093 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now | |
12094 better supported. | |
12095 | |
12096 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls | |
12097 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when | |
12098 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you | |
12099 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature; | |
12100 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar. | |
12101 | |
12102 *** A new format for menu items is supported. | |
12103 | |
12104 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format | |
12105 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING) | |
12106 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that | |
12107 starts with the symbol `menu-item'. | |
12108 | |
12109 The format is: | |
12110 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or | |
12111 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST) | |
12112 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item | |
12113 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list. | |
12114 The supported properties include | |
12115 | |
12116 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the | |
12117 item is enabled. | |
12118 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the | |
12119 item should appear in the menu. | |
12120 :filter FILTER-FN | |
12121 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument, | |
12122 which will be REAL-BINDING. | |
12123 It should return a binding to use instead. | |
12124 :keys DESCRIPTION | |
12125 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard | |
12126 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with | |
12127 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used. | |
12128 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE | |
12129 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent | |
12130 keyboard binding. | |
12131 :key-sequence nil | |
12132 This means that the command normally has no | |
12133 keyboard equivalent. | |
12134 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used). | |
12135 :button (TYPE . SELECTED) | |
12136 TYPE is :toggle or :radio. | |
12137 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its | |
12138 value says whether this button is currently selected. | |
12139 | |
12140 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu. | |
12141 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported. | |
12142 | |
12143 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item. | |
12144 | |
12145 ** New event types | |
12146 | |
12147 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a | |
12148 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that | |
12149 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated, | |
12150 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is: | |
12151 | |
12152 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA) | |
12153 | |
12154 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the | |
12155 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number | |
12156 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A | |
12157 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards | |
12158 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated | |
12159 forward, away from the user. | |
12160 | |
12161 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows. | |
12162 | |
12163 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of | |
12164 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged | |
12165 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of | |
12166 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically | |
12167 loaded into Emacs. The format is: | |
12168 | |
12169 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES) | |
12170 | |
12171 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the | |
12172 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames | |
12173 that were dragged and dropped. | |
12174 | |
12175 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows. | |
12176 | |
12177 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters. | |
12178 | |
12179 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only; | |
12180 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way | |
12181 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte. | |
12182 | |
12183 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You | |
12184 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character | |
12185 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape. | |
12186 | |
12187 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were | |
12188 in Emacs 19 and before. | |
12189 | |
12190 The function chars-in-string has been deleted. | |
12191 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'. | |
12192 | |
12193 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current | |
12194 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or | |
12195 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte | |
12196 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation. | |
12197 | |
12198 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed | |
12199 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents | |
12200 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as | |
12201 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation | |
12202 will count as two characters using unibyte representation. | |
12203 | |
12204 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which | |
12205 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer | |
12206 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are | |
12207 consistent with the new representation. | |
12208 | |
12209 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte | |
12210 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care | |
12211 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary; | |
12212 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings. | |
12213 | |
12214 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of | |
12215 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them | |
12216 using the table nonascii-translation-table. | |
12217 | |
12218 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte | |
12219 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the | |
12220 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings. | |
12221 | |
12222 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation | |
12223 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically | |
12224 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer. | |
12225 | |
12226 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string | |
12227 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte. | |
12228 | |
12229 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string | |
12230 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte. | |
12231 | |
12232 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare | |
12233 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte, | |
12234 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string. | |
12235 You can specify whether to ignore case or not. | |
12236 | |
12237 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that | |
12238 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal. | |
12239 | |
12240 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now | |
12241 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the | |
12242 buffer or string being searched. | |
12243 | |
12244 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of | |
12245 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when | |
12246 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when | |
12247 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no | |
12248 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what | |
12249 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular | |
12250 expression [^\0-\177] works for it. | |
12251 | |
12252 *** Structure of coding system changed. | |
12253 | |
12254 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named | |
12255 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector | |
12256 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector | |
12257 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this | |
12258 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define | |
12259 your own alias name of a coding system by the function | |
12260 define-coding-system-alias. | |
12261 | |
12262 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use | |
12263 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to | |
12264 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion, | |
12265 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode, | |
12266 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and | |
12267 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 | |
12268 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter | |
12269 `iso-8859-1'. | |
12270 | |
12271 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new. | |
12272 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this | |
12273 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance: | |
12274 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1) | |
12275 | |
12276 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can | |
12277 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they | |
12278 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode | |
12279 the other character sets and read it back correctly. | |
12280 | |
12281 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a | |
12282 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string. | |
12283 This function requires a user interaction. | |
12284 | |
12285 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and | |
12286 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by | |
12287 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding | |
12288 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want | |
12289 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of | |
12290 select-safe-coding-system. | |
12291 | |
12292 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as | |
12293 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set | |
12294 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding | |
12295 was done. | |
12296 | |
12297 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be | |
12298 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of | |
12299 coding systems used by some specific language environment. | |
12300 | |
12301 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always | |
12302 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII | |
12303 characters are found, they now return a list of single element | |
12304 `undecided' or its subsidiaries. | |
12305 | |
12306 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and | |
12307 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different | |
12308 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is | |
12309 converted. | |
12310 | |
12311 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a | |
12312 coding system for communicating with other X clients. | |
12313 | |
12314 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid | |
12315 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire | |
12316 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words, | |
12317 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value | |
12318 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a | |
12319 range of characters. | |
12320 | |
12321 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a | |
12322 Lisp object is a valid character code or not. | |
12323 | |
12324 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character | |
12325 in the current buffer at position POS. | |
12326 | |
12327 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable | |
12328 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a | |
12329 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing | |
12330 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the | |
12331 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first | |
12332 binding input-method-function to nil. | |
12333 | |
12334 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input | |
12335 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as | |
12336 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by | |
12337 the input method function are not passed to the input method function, | |
12338 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits. | |
12339 | |
12340 The input method function is not called when reading the second and | |
12341 subsequent events of a key sequence. | |
12342 | |
12343 *** You can customize any language environment by using | |
12344 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook. | |
12345 | |
12346 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo | |
12347 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For | |
12348 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language | |
12349 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up | |
12350 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding. | |
12351 | |
12352 * Changes in Emacs 20.1 | |
12353 | |
12354 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user | |
12355 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look | |
12356 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a | |
12357 tree structure. | |
12358 | |
12359 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each | |
12360 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values. | |
12361 | |
12362 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs | |
12363 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically | |
12364 in your .emacs file.) | |
12365 | |
12366 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window. | |
12367 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode. | |
12368 | |
12369 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'. | |
12370 This makes more space in the mode line for other information. | |
12371 | |
12372 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted | |
12373 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it | |
12374 kills the region. | |
12375 | |
12376 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they | |
12377 delete the character before point, as usual. | |
12378 | |
12379 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted | |
12380 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature | |
12381 by setting search-highlight to nil.) | |
12382 | |
12383 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to | |
12384 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect, | |
12385 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked | |
12386 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the | |
12387 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the | |
12388 past.) | |
12389 | |
12390 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs. | |
12391 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode | |
12392 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode). | |
12393 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this | |
12394 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs. | |
12395 | |
12396 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode, | |
12397 and is an alias for it. | |
12398 | |
12399 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph, | |
12400 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode. | |
12401 | |
12402 ** Scrolling changes | |
12403 | |
12404 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen | |
12405 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil. | |
12406 | |
12407 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing | |
12408 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line | |
12409 where it started. | |
12410 | |
12411 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you | |
12412 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the | |
12413 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that | |
12414 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines. | |
12415 | |
12416 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the | |
12417 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point | |
12418 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs | |
12419 recenters the window. | |
12420 | |
12421 ** International character set support (MULE) | |
12422 | |
12423 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets, | |
12424 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese, | |
12425 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese, | |
12426 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These | |
12427 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as | |
12428 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs") | |
12429 | |
12430 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard | |
12431 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte | |
12432 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide | |
12433 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back | |
12434 into any of these coding systems when saving a file. | |
12435 | |
12436 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used, | |
12437 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs | |
12438 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or | |
12439 language, to make it possible to type them. | |
12440 | |
12441 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII | |
12442 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377. | |
12443 | |
12444 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain | |
12445 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods. | |
12446 | |
12447 You can disable multibyte character support as follows: | |
12448 | |
12449 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil) | |
12450 | |
12451 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte | |
12452 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second | |
12453 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are | |
12454 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte | |
12455 characters for their work until they want to change. | |
12456 | |
12457 *** Input methods | |
12458 | |
12459 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed | |
12460 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language | |
12461 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use | |
12462 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages | |
12463 support several input methods. | |
12464 | |
12465 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into | |
12466 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods | |
12467 work. | |
12468 | |
12469 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of | |
12470 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use | |
12471 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which | |
12472 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one | |
12473 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single | |
12474 letter. | |
12475 | |
12476 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed | |
12477 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way. | |
12478 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone | |
12479 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are | |
12480 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character". | |
12481 | |
12482 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so | |
12483 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using | |
12484 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs | |
12485 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary. | |
12486 | |
12487 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled | |
12488 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use; | |
12489 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if | |
12490 the first guess is wrong. | |
12491 | |
12492 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters) | |
12493 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer. | |
12494 | |
12495 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each | |
12496 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as | |
12497 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for | |
12498 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2. | |
12499 | |
12500 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to | |
12501 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set | |
12502 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can | |
12503 translate automatically to and from either one. | |
12504 | |
12505 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode. | |
12506 | |
12507 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a | |
12508 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte | |
12509 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not | |
12510 what you want. | |
12511 | |
12512 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for | |
12513 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding | |
12514 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off | |
12515 multibyte characters in that buffer. | |
12516 | |
12517 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off | |
12518 character conversion as well. | |
12519 | |
12520 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows. | |
12521 | |
12522 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script. | |
12523 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports | |
12524 requires using many fonts. | |
12525 | |
12526 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a | |
12527 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes. | |
12528 | |
12529 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by | |
12530 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you | |
12531 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as | |
12532 you would use a font. | |
12533 | |
12534 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it | |
12535 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot | |
12536 display that character. It will display an empty box instead. | |
12537 | |
12538 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters | |
12539 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII | |
12540 characters). | |
12541 | |
12542 *** Defining fontsets. | |
12543 | |
12544 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still | |
12545 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset | |
12546 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource. | |
12547 | |
12548 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value | |
12549 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is | |
12550 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the | |
12551 standard fontset are created automatically. | |
12552 | |
12553 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn' | |
12554 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the | |
12555 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name | |
12556 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short | |
12557 name is `fontset-startup'. | |
12558 | |
12559 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2... | |
12560 The resource value should have this form: | |
12561 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]... | |
12562 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except: | |
12563 * most fields should be just the wild card "*". | |
12564 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset" | |
12565 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset. | |
12566 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number | |
12567 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set. | |
12568 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME | |
12569 should specify an actual font to use for that character set. | |
12570 | |
12571 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the | |
12572 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING. | |
12573 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name. | |
12574 | |
12575 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a | |
12576 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the | |
12577 following resource, | |
12578 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24 | |
12579 the font for ASCII is generated as below: | |
12580 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1 | |
12581 Here is the substitution rule: | |
12582 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset | |
12583 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has | |
12584 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce | |
12585 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-. | |
12586 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.) | |
12587 | |
12588 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the | |
12589 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call | |
12590 that function explicitly to create a fontset. | |
12591 | |
12592 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just | |
12593 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset | |
12594 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the | |
12595 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle | |
12596 fontsets. | |
12597 | |
12598 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs | |
12599 defaults for a particular choice of language. | |
12600 | |
12601 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input | |
12602 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when | |
12603 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have | |
12604 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The | |
12605 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding | |
12606 system for new files that you create. | |
12607 | |
12608 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use | |
12609 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the | |
12610 whole Emacs session. | |
12611 | |
12612 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET | |
12613 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this | |
12614 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1"). | |
12615 | |
12616 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) | |
12617 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This | |
12618 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving | |
12619 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the | |
12620 coding systems that Emacs supports. | |
12621 | |
12622 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument) | |
12623 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file. | |
12624 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name. | |
12625 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system | |
12626 is used for *the immediately following command*. | |
12627 | |
12628 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or | |
12629 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file. | |
12630 | |
12631 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system, | |
12632 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect. | |
12633 | |
12634 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET | |
12635 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1. | |
12636 | |
12637 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*- | |
12638 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*- | |
12639 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also | |
12640 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end | |
12641 of the file. | |
12642 | |
12643 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies | |
12644 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character | |
12645 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are | |
12646 translated into that character code. | |
12647 | |
12648 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in | |
12649 various countries to support the languages of those countries. | |
12650 | |
12651 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all. | |
12652 | |
12653 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies | |
12654 the coding system for keyboard input. | |
12655 | |
12656 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals | |
12657 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example, | |
12658 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it. | |
12659 | |
12660 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all. | |
12661 | |
12662 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an | |
12663 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that | |
12664 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed | |
12665 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are | |
12666 designed to work with terminals. | |
12667 | |
12668 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system) | |
12669 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess. | |
12670 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess | |
12671 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify | |
12672 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command | |
12673 in the corresponding buffer. | |
12674 | |
12675 By default, process input and output are not translated at all. | |
12676 | |
12677 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system | |
12678 to use for encoding file names before operating on them. | |
12679 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system. | |
12680 | |
12681 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates | |
12682 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the | |
12683 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you | |
12684 want to use. | |
12685 | |
12686 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input | |
12687 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method. | |
12688 | |
12689 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard | |
12690 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this | |
12691 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify | |
12692 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout. | |
12693 | |
12694 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays | |
12695 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus | |
12696 related information. | |
12697 | |
12698 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called | |
12699 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various | |
12700 scripts. | |
12701 | |
12702 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays | |
12703 information about the support for a particular language. | |
12704 You specify the language as an argument. | |
12705 | |
12706 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies | |
12707 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the | |
12708 first dash. | |
12709 | |
12710 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion | |
12711 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion | |
12712 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits | |
12713 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters: | |
12714 | |
12715 A alternativnyj (Russian) | |
12716 B big5 (Chinese) | |
12717 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese) | |
12718 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese) | |
12719 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages) | |
12720 E euc-japan (Japanese) | |
12721 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean) | |
12722 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese) | |
12723 K euc-korea (Korean) | |
12724 R koi8 (Russian) | |
12725 Q tibetan | |
12726 S shift_jis (Japanese) | |
12727 T lao | |
12728 T tis620 (Thai) | |
12729 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese) | |
12730 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean) | |
12731 k iso-2022-kr (Korean) | |
12732 v viqr (Vietnamese) | |
12733 z hz (Chinese) | |
12734 | |
12735 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system), | |
12736 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file | |
12737 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for | |
12738 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output. | |
12739 | |
12740 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code | |
12741 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil. | |
12742 | |
12743 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically | |
12744 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with | |
12745 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing | |
12746 Rmail files themselves. | |
12747 | |
12748 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code | |
12749 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil. | |
12750 | |
12751 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system | |
12752 for sending mail: | |
12753 | |
12754 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority. | |
12755 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it. | |
12756 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used, | |
12757 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment. | |
12758 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used. | |
12759 | |
12760 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument | |
12761 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English, | |
12762 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional | |
12763 translations. | |
12764 | |
12765 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion | |
12766 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command | |
12767 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer | |
12768 without any conversion. | |
12769 | |
12770 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed. | |
12771 You can now specify any number of octal digits. | |
12772 RET terminates the digits and is discarded; | |
12773 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input. | |
12774 | |
12775 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for | |
12776 functions, variables and file names used in your programs. | |
12777 | |
12778 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point. | |
12779 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point. | |
12780 | |
12781 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major | |
12782 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used. | |
12783 | |
12784 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command | |
12785 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name | |
12786 in the buffer before point. | |
12787 | |
12788 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of | |
12789 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that | |
12790 you are using. | |
12791 | |
12792 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables, | |
12793 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag). | |
12794 | |
12795 ** File locking works with NFS now. | |
12796 | |
12797 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME, | |
12798 in the same directory as FILENAME. | |
12799 | |
12800 This means that collision detection between two different machines now | |
12801 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory | |
12802 can become a bottleneck. | |
12803 | |
12804 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection | |
12805 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot | |
12806 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the | |
12807 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are | |
12808 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is | |
12809 so useful that the change is worth while. | |
12810 | |
12811 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which | |
12812 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious | |
12813 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just | |
12814 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway. | |
12815 | |
12816 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses, | |
12817 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call | |
12818 show-paren-mode. | |
12819 | |
12820 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted | |
12821 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load | |
12822 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode. | |
12823 | |
12824 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words | |
12825 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load | |
12826 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode. | |
12827 | |
12828 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you, | |
12829 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also | |
12830 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values. | |
12831 | |
12832 ** Changes in View mode. | |
12833 | |
12834 *** Several new commands are available in View mode. | |
12835 Do H in view mode for a list of commands. | |
12836 | |
12837 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode: | |
12838 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame. | |
12839 | |
12840 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their | |
12841 previous state. | |
12842 | |
12843 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil, | |
12844 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit. | |
12845 | |
12846 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If | |
12847 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer, | |
12848 not just the selected window. | |
12849 | |
12850 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a | |
12851 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only | |
12852 turns View mode on or off. | |
12853 | |
12854 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls | |
12855 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil, | |
12856 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it. | |
12857 | |
12858 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log, | |
12859 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version. | |
12860 | |
12861 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version, | |
12862 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is | |
12863 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks | |
12864 which version to compare with. | |
12865 | |
12866 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden | |
12867 blocks if a match is inside the block. | |
12868 | |
12869 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match | |
12870 is outside the block. By customizing the variable | |
12871 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily | |
12872 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search. | |
12873 | |
12874 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind | |
12875 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code | |
12876 blocks, all of them or none. | |
12877 | |
12878 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the | |
12879 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for | |
12880 confirmation first. | |
12881 | |
12882 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name, | |
12883 now changes the major mode according to that file name. | |
12884 However, the mode will not be changed if | |
12885 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or | |
12886 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode, | |
12887 not suitable for ordinary files, or | |
12888 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode. | |
12889 | |
12890 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well. | |
12891 | |
12892 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then | |
12893 these commands do not change the major mode. | |
12894 | |
12895 ** M-x occur changes. | |
12896 | |
12897 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters, | |
12898 it performs a case-sensitive search. | |
12899 | |
12900 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur, | |
12901 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search | |
12902 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before. | |
12903 | |
12904 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted | |
12905 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the | |
12906 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in | |
12907 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same | |
12908 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window. | |
12909 | |
12910 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates | |
12911 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings | |
12912 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents | |
12913 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information. | |
12914 | |
12915 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently | |
12916 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the | |
12917 buffers recently selected in the selected frame. | |
12918 | |
12919 ** Outline mode changes. | |
12920 | |
12921 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el). | |
12922 | |
12923 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode. | |
12924 | |
12925 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if | |
12926 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer. | |
12927 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that | |
12928 was already active. | |
12929 | |
12930 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not | |
12931 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then | |
12932 get confused by it. | |
12933 | |
12934 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must | |
12935 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil. | |
12936 | |
12937 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs. | |
12938 | |
12939 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case | |
12940 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first | |
12941 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion | |
12942 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim. | |
12943 | |
12944 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has | |
12945 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always | |
12946 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps. | |
12947 | |
12948 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search' | |
12949 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible | |
12950 values. | |
12951 | |
12952 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve | |
12953 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace). | |
12954 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore | |
12955 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search). | |
12956 | |
12957 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a | |
12958 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they | |
12959 can be. The default value is 30. | |
12960 | |
12961 ** Changes in Mail mode. | |
12962 | |
12963 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly. | |
12964 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail | |
12965 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable | |
12966 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is | |
12967 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old | |
12968 behavior. | |
12969 | |
12970 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs | |
12971 compose-mail-other-frame. | |
12972 | |
12973 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use | |
12974 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are | |
12975 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the | |
12976 buffer that shows the original message. | |
12977 | |
12978 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message, | |
12979 with separator lines around the contents. | |
12980 | |
12981 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases | |
12982 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias | |
12983 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not | |
12984 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail. | |
12985 | |
12986 *** New features in the mail-complete command. | |
12987 | |
12988 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name, | |
12989 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style | |
12990 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all. | |
12991 Its values are like those of mail-from-style. | |
12992 | |
12993 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command | |
12994 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in | |
12995 /etc/passwd. | |
12996 | |
12997 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read | |
12998 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used: | |
12999 /etc/passwd. | |
13000 | |
13001 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of | |
13002 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a | |
13003 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a | |
13004 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'. | |
13005 | |
13006 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as | |
13007 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise | |
13008 be taken to be magic. | |
13009 | |
13010 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select | |
13011 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is | |
13012 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep. | |
13013 | |
13014 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that. | |
13015 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.) | |
13016 | |
13017 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names | |
13018 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run. | |
13019 | |
13020 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands. | |
13021 | |
13022 new key dired.el binding old key | |
13023 ------- ---------------- ------- | |
13024 * c dired-change-marks c | |
13025 * m dired-mark m | |
13026 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted) | |
13027 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted) | |
13028 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted) | |
13029 * u dired-unmark u | |
13030 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL | |
13031 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-? | |
13032 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks | |
13033 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m | |
13034 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-} | |
13035 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{ | |
13036 | |
13037 ** Rmail changes. | |
13038 | |
13039 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it | |
13040 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer | |
13041 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing | |
13042 each time you run it. | |
13043 | |
13044 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls | |
13045 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes. | |
13046 | |
13047 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete | |
13048 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument | |
13049 means to move in the opposite direction. | |
13050 | |
13051 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets | |
13052 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned. | |
13053 | |
13054 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes | |
13055 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers. | |
13056 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you | |
13057 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used | |
13058 for output. | |
13059 | |
13060 ** Gnus changes. | |
13061 | |
13062 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion. | |
13063 | |
13064 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into | |
13065 Gnus. | |
13066 | |
13067 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like | |
13068 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection. | |
13069 | |
13070 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the | |
13071 article mode line. | |
13072 | |
13073 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files. | |
13074 | |
13075 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID. | |
13076 | |
13077 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t) | |
13078 | |
13079 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files | |
13080 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See | |
13081 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'. | |
13082 | |
13083 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics. | |
13084 | |
13085 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable. | |
13086 | |
13087 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions. | |
13088 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'. | |
13089 | |
13090 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like. | |
13091 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be | |
13092 used to pick articles. | |
13093 | |
13094 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to | |
13095 another have been added. | |
13096 | |
13097 `M-x gnus-change-server' | |
13098 | |
13099 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when | |
13100 generating lines in buffers. | |
13101 | |
13102 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with | |
13103 `C-M-_'. | |
13104 | |
13105 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'. | |
13106 | |
13107 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis: | |
13108 | |
13109 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word)) | |
13110 | |
13111 *** Scores can be decayed. | |
13112 | |
13113 (setq gnus-decay-scores t) | |
13114 | |
13115 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The | |
13116 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first. | |
13117 | |
13118 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from | |
13119 the native server. | |
13120 | |
13121 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups' | |
13122 | |
13123 *** A new command for reading collections of documents | |
13124 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'. | |
13125 | |
13126 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped. | |
13127 | |
13128 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post | |
13129 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting. | |
13130 | |
13131 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines | |
13132 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added. | |
13133 | |
13134 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such | |
13135 a group. | |
13136 | |
13137 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard | |
13138 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently. | |
13139 | |
13140 See the commands under the `T S' submap. | |
13141 | |
13142 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently. | |
13143 | |
13144 See the commands under the `G P' submap. | |
13145 | |
13146 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups. | |
13147 | |
13148 Use the `Y c' command. | |
13149 | |
13150 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order. | |
13151 | |
13152 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated. | |
13153 | |
13154 `M-x nnmail-split-history' | |
13155 | |
13156 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk | |
13157 from incoming mail before saving the mail. | |
13158 | |
13159 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'. | |
13160 | |
13161 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files. | |
13162 | |
13163 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute | |
13164 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs. | |
13165 | |
13166 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize) | |
13167 | |
13168 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically | |
13169 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime | |
13170 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this | |
13171 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling | |
13172 this issue.) | |
13173 | |
13174 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems | |
13175 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a | |
13176 particular news group. This can be done by: | |
13177 | |
13178 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM) | |
13179 | |
13180 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree | |
13181 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under | |
13182 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding | |
13183 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both | |
13184 for reading and posting). | |
13185 | |
13186 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form | |
13187 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM) | |
13188 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the | |
13189 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages | |
13190 there. | |
13191 | |
13192 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by | |
13193 default. Here are some of these default settings: | |
13194 | |
13195 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7) | |
13196 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312) | |
13197 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312) | |
13198 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5) | |
13199 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr)) | |
13200 | |
13201 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored; | |
13202 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual. | |
13203 | |
13204 ** CC mode changes. | |
13205 | |
13206 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java) | |
13207 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global | |
13208 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do | |
13209 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file. | |
13210 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is | |
13211 loaded. | |
13212 | |
13213 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, | |
13214 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode | |
13215 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers | |
13216 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set | |
13217 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you | |
13218 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded. | |
13219 | |
13220 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name | |
13221 of the current buffer. | |
13222 | |
13223 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because | |
13224 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles | |
13225 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use. | |
13226 | |
13227 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C | |
13228 style that the Python developers like. | |
13229 | |
13230 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace. | |
13231 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line, | |
13232 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line. | |
13233 | |
13234 ** VC Changes [new] | |
13235 | |
13236 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot | |
13237 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current | |
13238 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked). | |
13239 | |
13240 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common | |
13241 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other | |
13242 developers. | |
13243 | |
13244 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q | |
13245 RET in a buffer visiting that file. | |
13246 | |
13247 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by | |
13248 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a | |
13249 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then | |
13250 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it. | |
13251 | |
13252 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for | |
13253 version numbers, based on the current state of the file. | |
13254 | |
13255 ** Calendar changes. | |
13256 | |
13257 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or | |
13258 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow | |
13259 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the | |
13260 following/previous years. | |
13261 | |
13262 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in | |
13263 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i | |
13264 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days | |
13265 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The | |
13266 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a | |
13267 supposed attribute of God. | |
13268 | |
13269 ** ps-print changes | |
13270 | |
13271 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page | |
13272 layout. | |
13273 | |
13274 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup) | |
13275 | |
13276 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to | |
13277 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your | |
13278 printer system has this behavior, set variable | |
13279 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t. | |
13280 | |
13281 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a | |
13282 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the | |
13283 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014). | |
13284 | |
13285 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for | |
13286 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are: | |
13287 | |
13288 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'. | |
13289 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex | |
13290 printing for your printer. | |
13291 | |
13292 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the | |
13293 setpagedevice PostScript operator. | |
13294 | |
13295 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using | |
13296 the setpagedevice PostScript operator. | |
13297 | |
13298 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on | |
13299 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If | |
13300 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for | |
13301 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil, | |
13302 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom. | |
13303 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil. | |
13304 The default value is nil. | |
13305 | |
13306 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame | |
13307 properties alist. Valid frame properties are: | |
13308 | |
13309 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color. | |
13310 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black | |
13311 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a | |
13312 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which | |
13313 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each | |
13314 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright | |
13315 color). The default is 0 ("black"). | |
13316 | |
13317 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color). | |
13318 The default is 0.9 ("gray90"). | |
13319 | |
13320 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color). | |
13321 The default is 0 ("black"). | |
13322 | |
13323 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color). | |
13324 The default is 0 ("black"). | |
13325 | |
13326 border-width Specify the border width. | |
13327 The default is 0.4. | |
13328 | |
13329 Any other property is ignored. | |
13330 | |
13331 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the | |
13332 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for | |
13333 documentation). | |
13334 | |
13335 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are: | |
13336 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame', | |
13337 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad', | |
13338 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and | |
13339 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those | |
13340 controlling headers. | |
13341 | |
13342 *** Color management (subgroup) | |
13343 | |
13344 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in | |
13345 color. | |
13346 | |
13347 *** Face Management (subgroup) | |
13348 | |
13349 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors, | |
13350 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face | |
13351 background should be used. Valid values are: | |
13352 | |
13353 t always use face background color. | |
13354 nil never use face background color. | |
13355 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used. | |
13356 | |
13357 *** N-up printing (subgroup) | |
13358 | |
13359 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per | |
13360 sheet of paper. | |
13361 | |
13362 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt) | |
13363 between the sheet border and the n-up printing. | |
13364 | |
13365 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around | |
13366 each page. | |
13367 | |
13368 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled | |
13369 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for | |
13370 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix: | |
13371 | |
13372 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12 | |
13373 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8 | |
13374 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4 | |
13375 | |
13376 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9 | |
13377 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5 | |
13378 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1 | |
13379 | |
13380 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12 | |
13381 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11 | |
13382 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10 | |
13383 | |
13384 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3 | |
13385 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2 | |
13386 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1 | |
13387 | |
13388 Any other value is treated as `left-top'. | |
13389 | |
13390 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup) | |
13391 | |
13392 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or | |
13393 RGB color. | |
13394 | |
13395 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes | |
13396 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+' | |
13397 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed): | |
13398 | |
13399 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow' | |
13400 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ---------------- | |
13401 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX + | |
13402 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX + | |
13403 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX + | |
13404 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 + | |
13405 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 + | |
13406 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 + | |
13407 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX + | |
13408 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX + | |
13409 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX + | |
13410 10 + 10 + | |
13411 11 + 11 + | |
13412 -------- ----------- --------- ---------------- | |
13413 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ---------------- | |
13414 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 + | |
13415 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 + | |
13416 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 + | |
13417 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX + | |
13418 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX + | |
13419 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX + | |
13420 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 + | |
13421 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 + | |
13422 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 + | |
13423 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX + | |
13424 22 + 22 + | |
13425 -------- ----------- --------- ---------------- | |
13426 | |
13427 Any other value is treated as `nil'. | |
13428 | |
13429 | |
13430 *** Printer management (subgroup) | |
13431 | |
13432 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by | |
13433 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when | |
13434 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr | |
13435 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set | |
13436 to "-P". | |
13437 | |
13438 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual | |
13439 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's | |
13440 non-nil, manual feeding takes place. | |
13441 | |
13442 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04) | |
13443 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means | |
13444 do so. | |
13445 | |
13446 *** Page settings (subgroup) | |
13447 | |
13448 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an | |
13449 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size | |
13450 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used | |
13451 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if | |
13452 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated | |
13453 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to | |
13454 `setpagedevice'. | |
13455 | |
13456 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for | |
13457 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means | |
13458 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees). | |
13459 | |
13460 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If | |
13461 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be | |
13462 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO) | |
13463 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that | |
13464 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than | |
13465 its TO, are ignored. | |
13466 | |
13467 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd | |
13468 pages. Valid values are: | |
13469 | |
13470 nil print all pages. | |
13471 | |
13472 `even-page' print only even pages. | |
13473 | |
13474 `odd-page' print only odd pages. | |
13475 | |
13476 `even-sheet' print only even sheets. | |
13477 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like | |
13478 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll | |
13479 print only the even sheet of paper. | |
13480 | |
13481 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets. | |
13482 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like | |
13483 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print | |
13484 only the odd sheet of paper. | |
13485 | |
13486 Any other value is treated as nil. | |
13487 | |
13488 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages | |
13489 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by | |
13490 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have: | |
13491 | |
13492 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20)) | |
13493 | |
13494 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and | |
13495 `ps-n-up-printing', we get: | |
13496 | |
13497 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1: | |
13498 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED | |
13499 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20 | |
13500 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20 | |
13501 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15 | |
13502 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20 | |
13503 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15 | |
13504 | |
13505 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2: | |
13506 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED | |
13507 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20 | |
13508 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20 | |
13509 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15 | |
13510 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16 | |
13511 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20 | |
13512 | |
13513 *** Miscellany (subgroup) | |
13514 | |
13515 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler | |
13516 messages should be sent. | |
13517 | |
13518 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in | |
13519 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable | |
13520 `ps-user-defined-prologue'. | |
13521 | |
13522 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers. | |
13523 | |
13524 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in | |
13525 points for line numbers. | |
13526 | |
13527 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line | |
13528 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation. | |
13529 | |
13530 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which | |
13531 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set | |
13532 to 2, the printing will look like: | |
13533 | |
13534 1 one line | |
13535 one line | |
13536 3 one line | |
13537 one line | |
13538 5 one line | |
13539 one line | |
13540 ... | |
13541 | |
13542 Valid values are: | |
13543 | |
13544 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are | |
13545 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1 | |
13546 is used. | |
13547 | |
13548 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a | |
13549 zebra stripe is to be printed. | |
13550 | |
13551 Any other value is treated as `zebra'. | |
13552 | |
13553 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in | |
13554 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if | |
13555 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to | |
13556 3, the output will look like: | |
13557 | |
13558 one line | |
13559 one line | |
13560 3 one line | |
13561 one line | |
13562 one line | |
13563 6 one line | |
13564 one line | |
13565 one line | |
13566 9 one line | |
13567 one line | |
13568 ... | |
13569 | |
13570 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory | |
13571 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found. | |
13572 | |
13573 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points, | |
13574 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to | |
13575 `ps-font-size'). | |
13576 | |
13577 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing, | |
13578 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to | |
13579 `ps-font-size'). | |
13580 | |
13581 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter. | |
13582 | |
13583 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the | |
13584 start and end of a region to cut out when printing. | |
13585 | |
13586 ** hideshow changes. | |
13587 | |
13588 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for | |
13589 C++, ; for lisp). | |
13590 | |
13591 *** Support for java-mode added. | |
13592 | |
13593 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments | |
13594 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set. | |
13595 | |
13596 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at | |
13597 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your | |
13598 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'. | |
13599 | |
13600 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more | |
13601 robust and a lot faster. | |
13602 | |
13603 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines. | |
13604 | |
13605 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow | |
13606 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the | |
13607 documentation for more details. | |
13608 | |
13609 ** Changes in Enriched mode. | |
13610 | |
13611 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is | |
13612 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent | |
13613 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in | |
13614 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled | |
13615 the next time unless the fill-column is different. | |
13616 | |
13617 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs | |
13618 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines | |
13619 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked | |
13620 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text. | |
13621 | |
13622 ** Font Lock mode | |
13623 | |
13624 *** Custom support | |
13625 | |
13626 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and | |
13627 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify | |
13628 the faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new | |
13629 custom group font-lock-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in your | |
13630 ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should | |
13631 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize. | |
13632 | |
13633 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances. | |
13634 | |
13635 *** Maximum decoration | |
13636 | |
13637 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by | |
13638 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level | |
13639 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration | |
13640 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil | |
13641 to get the old behavior. | |
13642 | |
13643 *** New support | |
13644 | |
13645 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes. | |
13646 | |
13647 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes | |
13648 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode. | |
13649 | |
13650 *** Configurable support | |
13651 | |
13652 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for | |
13653 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types, | |
13654 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it, | |
13655 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a | |
13656 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value | |
13657 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the | |
13658 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification. | |
13659 | |
13660 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever | |
13661 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make | |
13662 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types. | |
13663 | |
13664 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support | |
13665 | |
13666 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own | |
13667 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs, | |
13668 for any mode. | |
13669 | |
13670 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put: | |
13671 | |
13672 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t))) | |
13673 | |
13674 in your ~/.emacs. | |
13675 | |
13676 *** New faces | |
13677 | |
13678 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and | |
13679 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords, | |
13680 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought | |
13681 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces. | |
13682 | |
13683 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode | |
13684 | |
13685 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process | |
13686 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the | |
13687 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature. | |
13688 | |
13689 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode | |
13690 | |
13691 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify | |
13692 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use | |
13693 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If | |
13694 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be | |
13695 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only | |
13696 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy | |
13697 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode. | |
13698 | |
13699 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines. | |
13700 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if | |
13701 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly | |
13702 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line | |
13703 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use | |
13704 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines. | |
13705 | |
13706 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed: | |
13707 | |
13708 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'. | |
13709 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number. | |
13710 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the | |
13711 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'. | |
13712 | |
13713 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those | |
13714 settings. | |
13715 | |
13716 ** Ada mode changes. | |
13717 | |
13718 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode. | |
13719 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same | |
13720 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but | |
13721 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure | |
13722 stubs. | |
13723 | |
13724 *** There are two new commands: | |
13725 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer | |
13726 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer. | |
13727 | |
13728 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options', | |
13729 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and | |
13730 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands. | |
13731 | |
13732 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level | |
13733 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs. | |
13734 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented. | |
13735 | |
13736 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of | |
13737 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start, | |
13738 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one | |
13739 space between a comma and the beginning of a word. | |
13740 | |
13741 ** Scheme mode changes. | |
13742 | |
13743 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp | |
13744 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used | |
13745 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables | |
13746 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer | |
13747 have any effect. | |
13748 | |
13749 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is | |
13750 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to | |
13751 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation | |
13752 variables as buffer-local variables. | |
13753 | |
13754 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts. | |
13755 Use M-x dsssl-mode. | |
13756 | |
13757 ** Changes to the emacsclient program | |
13758 | |
13759 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or | |
13760 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID | |
13761 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root | |
13762 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user. | |
13763 | |
13764 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells | |
13765 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the | |
13766 buffer in Emacs. | |
13767 | |
13768 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to | |
13769 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable | |
13770 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line | |
13771 option takes precedence. | |
13772 | |
13773 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area | |
13774 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point | |
13775 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only). | |
13776 | |
13777 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun, | |
13778 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just | |
13779 the current defun. | |
13780 | |
13781 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all | |
13782 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names. | |
13783 | |
13784 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk, | |
13785 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if | |
13786 necessary). | |
13787 | |
13788 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file, | |
13789 if there are any registers that save positions in the file, | |
13790 these register values no longer become completely useless. | |
13791 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are | |
13792 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes, | |
13793 it visits the file and then goes to the same position. | |
13794 | |
13795 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for | |
13796 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may | |
13797 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever | |
13798 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f. | |
13799 | |
13800 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the | |
13801 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a | |
13802 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and | |
13803 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but | |
13804 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself. | |
13805 | |
13806 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font | |
13807 since it applies only to the current frame. | |
13808 | |
13809 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the | |
13810 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil, | |
13811 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.) | |
13812 | |
13813 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of | |
13814 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local | |
13815 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for | |
13816 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document | |
13817 instead of just the file you are editing. | |
13818 | |
13819 ** RefTeX mode | |
13820 | |
13821 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref | |
13822 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of | |
13823 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for | |
13824 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and | |
13825 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands: | |
13826 | |
13827 C-c ( reftex-label | |
13828 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and | |
13829 knows which kind of label is needed. | |
13830 | |
13831 C-c ) reftex-reference | |
13832 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the | |
13833 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}. | |
13834 | |
13835 C-c [ reftex-citation | |
13836 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX | |
13837 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro. | |
13838 | |
13839 C-c & reftex-view-crossref | |
13840 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point. | |
13841 | |
13842 C-c = reftex-toc | |
13843 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you | |
13844 can quickly jump to every section. | |
13845 | |
13846 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional | |
13847 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature. | |
13848 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file | |
13849 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation: | |
13850 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el | |
13851 | |
13852 ** Changes in BibTeX mode. | |
13853 | |
13854 *** Info documentation is now available. | |
13855 | |
13856 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused | |
13857 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode. | |
13858 | |
13859 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to | |
13860 bibtex-user-optional-fields. | |
13861 | |
13862 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote | |
13863 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead). | |
13864 | |
13865 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete | |
13866 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by | |
13867 appropriate functions. | |
13868 | |
13869 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of | |
13870 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h. | |
13871 | |
13872 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has | |
13873 been cleaned. | |
13874 | |
13875 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables | |
13876 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter. | |
13877 | |
13878 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries | |
13879 shall be delimited. | |
13880 | |
13881 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of | |
13882 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and | |
13883 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details. | |
13884 | |
13885 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor | |
13886 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are | |
13887 prefixed with `ALT'. | |
13888 | |
13889 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable | |
13890 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many | |
13891 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable | |
13892 documentation). | |
13893 | |
13894 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See | |
13895 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions | |
13896 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too. | |
13897 | |
13898 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if | |
13899 comma should be inserted at end of last field. | |
13900 | |
13901 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if | |
13902 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal | |
13903 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation). | |
13904 | |
13905 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries. | |
13906 | |
13907 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer. | |
13908 | |
13909 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database | |
13910 from alien sources. | |
13911 | |
13912 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string) | |
13913 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in | |
13914 crossref entries. | |
13915 | |
13916 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or | |
13917 region. | |
13918 | |
13919 *** Added support for imenu. | |
13920 | |
13921 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead | |
13922 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a | |
13923 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g. | |
13924 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors. | |
13925 | |
13926 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files | |
13927 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched. | |
13928 | |
13929 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative. | |
13930 | |
13931 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow. | |
13932 | |
13933 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the | |
13934 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem. | |
13935 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory | |
13936 as an argument. | |
13937 | |
13938 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read | |
13939 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed). | |
13940 | |
13941 ** browse-url changes | |
13942 | |
13943 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm), | |
13944 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window | |
13945 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic | |
13946 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated | |
13947 customization variables. | |
13948 | |
13949 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'. | |
13950 | |
13951 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across | |
13952 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps | |
13953 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'. | |
13954 | |
13955 ** Changes in Ediff | |
13956 | |
13957 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel | |
13958 pops up the Info file for this command. | |
13959 | |
13960 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether | |
13961 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when | |
13962 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different | |
13963 directories). | |
13964 | |
13965 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare | |
13966 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of | |
13967 files in the same directory. | |
13968 | |
13969 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively. | |
13970 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug | |
13971 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.) | |
13972 | |
13973 ** Changes in Viper | |
13974 | |
13975 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip | |
13976 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper- | |
13977 instead of vip-. | |
13978 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states. | |
13979 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next | |
13980 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before. | |
13981 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states. | |
13982 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state. | |
13983 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor | |
13984 color when Viper is in insert state. | |
13985 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window, | |
13986 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable | |
13987 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior. | |
13988 | |
13989 ** Etags changes. | |
13990 | |
13991 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by | |
13992 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average. | |
13993 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag | |
13994 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does | |
13995 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on. | |
13996 | |
13997 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags. | |
13998 | |
13999 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements" | |
14000 constructs are tagged. Files are recognized by the extension .java. | |
14001 | |
14002 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are | |
14003 recognized by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax). | |
14004 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash. | |
14005 | |
14006 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and | |
14007 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags | |
14008 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories, | |
14009 methods and protocols. | |
14010 | |
14011 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognized by the extension | |
14012 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in | |
14013 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a | |
14014 paragraph name. | |
14015 | |
14016 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of | |
14017 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression | |
14018 at least M times and as many as N times. | |
14019 | |
14020 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert | |
14021 in files has changed slightly. | |
14022 | |
14023 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string, | |
14024 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it. | |
14025 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility | |
14026 with old time-stamp-format values. | |
14027 | |
14028 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign | |
14029 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character. | |
14030 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility | |
14031 reasons. | |
14032 | |
14033 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their | |
14034 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a | |
14035 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon | |
14036 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical | |
14037 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are | |
14038 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d". | |
14039 | |
14040 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the | |
14041 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit | |
14042 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway. | |
14043 | |
14044 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are | |
14045 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the | |
14046 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being | |
14047 recommended now will continue to work then. | |
14048 | |
14049 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for | |
14050 details. | |
14051 | |
14052 ** There are some additional major modes: | |
14053 | |
14054 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files. | |
14055 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input. | |
14056 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files. | |
14057 | |
14058 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you | |
14059 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell | |
14060 into Emacs. | |
14061 | |
14062 ** New Lisp packages include: | |
14063 | |
14064 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops. | |
14065 | |
14066 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might | |
14067 be used for adding some indecent words to your email. | |
14068 | |
14069 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor. | |
14070 | |
14071 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes | |
14072 in shell buffers. | |
14073 | |
14074 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code. | |
14075 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer' | |
14076 and `elint-defun'. | |
14077 | |
14078 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is | |
14079 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary | |
14080 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within | |
14081 strings or comments. | |
14082 | |
14083 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an | |
14084 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev, | |
14085 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these | |
14086 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text | |
14087 at these points. | |
14088 | |
14089 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you | |
14090 can visit them by short forms of their names. | |
14091 | |
14092 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded | |
14093 Emacs Lisp function at point. | |
14094 | |
14095 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture. | |
14096 | |
14097 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like | |
14098 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way. | |
14099 | |
14100 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning. | |
14101 | |
14102 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program. | |
14103 | |
14104 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input. | |
14105 | |
14106 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations | |
14107 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed. | |
14108 | |
14109 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature. | |
14110 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically | |
14111 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its | |
14112 original place after inserting the copy. | |
14113 | |
14114 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2 | |
14115 on the buffer. | |
14116 | |
14117 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the | |
14118 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll | |
14119 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed. | |
14120 | |
14121 Enable mouse-drag with: | |
14122 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw) | |
14123 -or- | |
14124 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag) | |
14125 | |
14126 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have | |
14127 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail. | |
14128 | |
14129 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave. | |
14130 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess. | |
14131 | |
14132 *** ogonek | |
14133 | |
14134 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of | |
14135 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various | |
14136 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and | |
14137 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to | |
14138 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to | |
14139 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for | |
14140 instance) and vice versa. | |
14141 | |
14142 To use this package load it using | |
14143 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek | |
14144 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of | |
14145 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish | |
14146 M-x ogonek-how -- in English | |
14147 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the | |
14148 ways of customization in `.emacs'. | |
14149 | |
14150 *** Interface to ph. | |
14151 | |
14152 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi) | |
14153 | |
14154 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory | |
14155 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to | |
14156 these servers. | |
14157 | |
14158 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email. | |
14159 | |
14160 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature. | |
14161 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands | |
14162 while the real cursor does not move. | |
14163 | |
14164 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up | |
14165 for visiting your favorite web sites. | |
14166 | |
14167 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations, | |
14168 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used. | |
14169 | |
14170 ** movemail change | |
14171 | |
14172 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP | |
14173 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer | |
14174 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the | |
14175 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server. | |
14176 | |
14177 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before. | |
14178 | |
14179 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows. | |
14180 | |
14181 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files. | |
14182 | |
14183 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing | |
14184 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the | |
14185 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific | |
14186 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special | |
14187 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention. | |
14188 | |
14189 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use | |
14190 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different | |
14191 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly | |
14192 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with | |
14193 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to | |
14194 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos. | |
14195 | |
14196 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1 | |
14197 | |
14198 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in | |
14199 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And | |
14200 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in | |
14201 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20. | |
14202 | |
14203 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed | |
14204 to start with w32- instead of win32-. | |
14205 | |
14206 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We | |
14207 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it | |
14208 "win". | |
14209 | |
14210 ** Basic Lisp changes | |
14211 | |
14212 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically | |
14213 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant. | |
14214 | |
14215 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now | |
14216 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program | |
14217 or by the user. | |
14218 | |
14219 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed. | |
14220 | |
14221 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless' | |
14222 | |
14223 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...)) | |
14224 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...) | |
14225 | |
14226 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their | |
14227 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of | |
14228 its argument. | |
14229 | |
14230 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties. | |
14231 | |
14232 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function. | |
14233 | |
14234 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors. | |
14235 | |
14236 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an | |
14237 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives | |
14238 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the | |
14239 `format' function. | |
14240 | |
14241 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el | |
14242 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file | |
14243 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc. | |
14244 | |
14245 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain | |
14246 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on | |
14247 adding one of these suffixes. | |
14248 | |
14249 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE | |
14250 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer. | |
14251 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used. | |
14252 | |
14253 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers, | |
14254 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful. | |
14255 | |
14256 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings. | |
14257 | |
14258 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally. | |
14259 You must load the `cl' library to define it. | |
14260 | |
14261 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression | |
14262 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this: | |
14263 | |
14264 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...) | |
14265 | |
14266 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use. | |
14267 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer. | |
14268 | |
14269 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the | |
14270 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or | |
14271 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer' | |
14272 works using `save-current-buffer'. | |
14273 | |
14274 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and | |
14275 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value | |
14276 of the last form. | |
14277 | |
14278 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer, | |
14279 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the | |
14280 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string) | |
14281 as the last form. | |
14282 | |
14283 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain | |
14284 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the | |
14285 matches. | |
14286 | |
14287 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose"). | |
14288 | |
14289 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions | |
14290 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string. | |
14291 Then it returns that string. | |
14292 | |
14293 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo', | |
14294 | |
14295 (with-output-to-string | |
14296 (princ "The buffer is ") | |
14297 (princ (buffer-name))) | |
14298 | |
14299 returns "The buffer is foo". | |
14300 | |
14301 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters | |
14302 is non-nil. | |
14303 | |
14304 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the | |
14305 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte | |
14306 characters that occupy several buffer positions each. | |
14307 | |
14308 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in | |
14309 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four). | |
14310 | |
14311 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements; | |
14312 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes. | |
14313 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer | |
14314 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole | |
14315 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to | |
14316 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))). | |
14317 | |
14318 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always. | |
14319 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent | |
14320 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte | |
14321 characters". | |
14322 | |
14323 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128 | |
14324 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called | |
14325 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the | |
14326 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the | |
14327 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is. | |
14328 | |
14329 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore | |
14330 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a | |
14331 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a | |
14332 character, which may be more than one buffer position. | |
14333 | |
14334 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is | |
14335 always one buffer position, need to be changed. | |
14336 | |
14337 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position. | |
14338 | |
14339 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters, | |
14340 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters | |
14341 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However, | |
14342 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters, | |
14343 guaranteed. | |
14344 | |
14345 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is | |
14346 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a | |
14347 character). | |
14348 | |
14349 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS: | |
14350 | |
14351 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range, | |
14352 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form, | |
14353 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form, | |
14354 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form, | |
14355 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character. | |
14356 | |
14357 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses. | |
14358 | |
14359 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function | |
14360 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be | |
14361 more than the number of characters. | |
14362 | |
14363 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing | |
14364 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape, | |
14365 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which | |
14366 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to | |
14367 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and | |
14368 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape. | |
14369 | |
14370 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters | |
14371 and returns a string containing those characters. | |
14372 | |
14373 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string. | |
14374 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX | |
14375 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a | |
14376 character, sref signals an error. | |
14377 | |
14378 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters | |
14379 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the | |
14380 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes). | |
14381 | |
14382 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters | |
14383 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the | |
14384 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes). | |
14385 | |
14386 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of | |
14387 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string | |
14388 to a vector of the characters in it. | |
14389 | |
14390 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents | |
14391 of a string. You call it as follows: | |
14392 | |
14393 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ) | |
14394 | |
14395 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in | |
14396 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string. | |
14397 This function really does alter the contents of STRING. | |
14398 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string, | |
14399 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length. | |
14400 | |
14401 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR, | |
14402 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window. | |
14403 | |
14404 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING, | |
14405 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window. | |
14406 | |
14407 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary, | |
14408 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does | |
14409 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string | |
14410 which contains all or just part of the existing string.) | |
14411 | |
14412 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING) | |
14413 | |
14414 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN. | |
14415 | |
14416 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column. | |
14417 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string | |
14418 are not included in the resulting value. | |
14419 | |
14420 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added | |
14421 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly | |
14422 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING | |
14423 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING. | |
14424 | |
14425 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean | |
14426 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one | |
14427 character extends across that column), then the padding character | |
14428 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result | |
14429 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at | |
14430 column START-COLUMN. | |
14431 | |
14432 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called, | |
14433 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not | |
14434 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the | |
14435 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the | |
14436 changed text, before the change. | |
14437 | |
14438 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character | |
14439 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is | |
14440 one character set for each script, not for each language. | |
14441 | |
14442 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name. | |
14443 | |
14444 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names. | |
14445 | |
14446 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character | |
14447 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.) | |
14448 | |
14449 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the | |
14450 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values | |
14451 which identify the character within that character set. | |
14452 | |
14453 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent | |
14454 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the | |
14455 opposite of split-char. | |
14456 | |
14457 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets | |
14458 of all the characters between BEG and END. | |
14459 | |
14460 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets | |
14461 of all the characters in a string. | |
14462 | |
14463 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems | |
14464 and specifying coding systems. | |
14465 | |
14466 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding | |
14467 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list | |
14468 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants. | |
14469 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix | |
14470 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well | |
14471 as what to do about code conversion.) | |
14472 | |
14473 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system | |
14474 name. It returns t if so, nil if not. | |
14475 | |
14476 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use | |
14477 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist, | |
14478 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name. | |
14479 | |
14480 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines | |
14481 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp | |
14482 to match against a file name. | |
14483 | |
14484 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or | |
14485 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both | |
14486 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent | |
14487 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding | |
14488 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr | |
14489 specifies the coding system for encoding. | |
14490 | |
14491 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system | |
14492 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above. | |
14493 | |
14494 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies | |
14495 the coding system to use for network sockets. | |
14496 | |
14497 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines | |
14498 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be | |
14499 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network | |
14500 service names. | |
14501 | |
14502 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or | |
14503 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both | |
14504 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent | |
14505 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding | |
14506 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr | |
14507 specifies the coding system for encoding. | |
14508 | |
14509 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system | |
14510 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above. | |
14511 | |
14512 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use | |
14513 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist, | |
14514 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to | |
14515 start the subprocess. | |
14516 | |
14517 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding | |
14518 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output, | |
14519 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell | |
14520 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output | |
14521 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it. | |
14522 | |
14523 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the | |
14524 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous | |
14525 subprocess. | |
14526 | |
14527 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection, | |
14528 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you | |
14529 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or | |
14530 connection permanently or until overridden. | |
14531 | |
14532 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over | |
14533 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and | |
14534 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a | |
14535 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil. | |
14536 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding | |
14537 system for one operation at a time. | |
14538 | |
14539 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from | |
14540 files, subprocesses or network connections. | |
14541 | |
14542 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what | |
14543 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using. | |
14544 The value is a cons cell, | |
14545 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM) | |
14546 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from | |
14547 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding | |
14548 input to the subprocess. | |
14549 | |
14550 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to | |
14551 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess. | |
14552 | |
14553 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many | |
14554 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility, | |
14555 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom. | |
14556 | |
14557 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option | |
14558 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of | |
14559 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are | |
14560 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for | |
14561 customization. | |
14562 | |
14563 Thus, instead of writing | |
14564 | |
14565 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil | |
14566 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.") | |
14567 | |
14568 you would now write this: | |
14569 | |
14570 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil | |
14571 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely." | |
14572 :type 'boolean | |
14573 :group foo) | |
14574 | |
14575 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only | |
14576 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values | |
14577 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom | |
14578 for a description of them. | |
14579 | |
14580 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option | |
14581 should belong to. You define a new group like this: | |
14582 | |
14583 (defgroup ispell nil | |
14584 "Spell checking using Ispell." | |
14585 :group 'processes) | |
14586 | |
14587 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root | |
14588 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself, | |
14589 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond | |
14590 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come | |
14591 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages. | |
14592 | |
14593 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple | |
14594 package should have just one group; a more complex package should | |
14595 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a | |
14596 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword" | |
14597 first-level subgroups. | |
14598 | |
14599 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers. | |
14600 | |
14601 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a | |
14602 separate manual that accompanies Emacs. | |
14603 | |
14604 ** easy-mmode | |
14605 | |
14606 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make | |
14607 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code | |
14608 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles, | |
14609 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro | |
14610 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also | |
14611 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'. | |
14612 | |
14613 ** Text property changes | |
14614 | |
14615 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a | |
14616 text property. | |
14617 | |
14618 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and | |
14619 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a | |
14620 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The | |
14621 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the | |
14622 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan. | |
14623 | |
14624 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If | |
14625 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part | |
14626 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the | |
14627 position of the beginning or end of the buffer. | |
14628 | |
14629 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property | |
14630 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This | |
14631 is an alternative to using the keymap itself. | |
14632 | |
14633 ** Changes in invisibility features | |
14634 | |
14635 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are | |
14636 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match | |
14637 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay | |
14638 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that | |
14639 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should | |
14640 make the overlay visible. | |
14641 | |
14642 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the | |
14643 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are | |
14644 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary | |
14645 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is | |
14646 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and | |
14647 t when it should hide it. | |
14648 | |
14649 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec | |
14650 | |
14651 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the | |
14652 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol) | |
14653 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol. | |
14654 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to | |
14655 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'. | |
14656 Here is an example of how to do this: | |
14657 | |
14658 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis: | |
14659 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t)) | |
14660 ;; If you don't want ellipsis: | |
14661 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol) | |
14662 | |
14663 ... | |
14664 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol) | |
14665 | |
14666 ... | |
14667 ;; When done with the overlays: | |
14668 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t)) | |
14669 ;; Or respectively: | |
14670 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol) | |
14671 | |
14672 ** Changes in syntax parsing. | |
14673 | |
14674 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as | |
14675 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now | |
14676 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable | |
14677 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil. | |
14678 | |
14679 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior | |
14680 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always | |
14681 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position. | |
14682 | |
14683 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a | |
14684 character in the buffer is calculated thus: | |
14685 | |
14686 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character | |
14687 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type; | |
14688 | |
14689 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid | |
14690 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e., | |
14691 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR). | |
14692 | |
14693 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property | |
14694 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used | |
14695 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to | |
14696 determine the syntax type of the character. | |
14697 | |
14698 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table | |
14699 of the current buffer. | |
14700 | |
14701 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the | |
14702 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as | |
14703 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions. | |
14704 | |
14705 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14 | |
14706 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended | |
14707 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A | |
14708 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by | |
14709 another character with the same code (unless quoted). | |
14710 | |
14711 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table' | |
14712 text property. | |
14713 | |
14714 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth | |
14715 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start | |
14716 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string. | |
14717 | |
14718 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp' | |
14719 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth | |
14720 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string; | |
14721 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the | |
14722 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code. | |
14723 | |
14724 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete | |
14725 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports | |
14726 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'. | |
14727 | |
14728 ** Changes in face features | |
14729 | |
14730 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even | |
14731 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces. | |
14732 | |
14733 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string | |
14734 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one). | |
14735 | |
14736 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold. | |
14737 set-face-bold-p sets that flag. | |
14738 | |
14739 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic. | |
14740 set-face-italic-p sets that flag. | |
14741 | |
14742 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text | |
14743 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME) | |
14744 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in | |
14745 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an | |
14746 overlay property). | |
14747 | |
14748 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use | |
14749 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package. | |
14750 | |
14751 ** Changes in file-handling functions | |
14752 | |
14753 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant | |
14754 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words, | |
14755 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion | |
14756 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name. | |
14757 | |
14758 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name | |
14759 begins with ~. | |
14760 | |
14761 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file, | |
14762 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error. | |
14763 | |
14764 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if | |
14765 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers. | |
14766 | |
14767 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file, | |
14768 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil. | |
14769 | |
14770 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses | |
14771 character code conversion as well as other things. | |
14772 | |
14773 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names | |
14774 (formerly it did not). | |
14775 | |
14776 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR | |
14777 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in. | |
14778 | |
14779 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps | |
14780 instead of constant strings. | |
14781 | |
14782 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used | |
14783 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of | |
14784 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through. | |
14785 | |
14786 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially, | |
14787 in the same way as before. | |
14788 | |
14789 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now. | |
14790 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings | |
14791 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion. | |
14792 | |
14793 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an | |
14794 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing | |
14795 else, and returns nil. | |
14796 | |
14797 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified | |
14798 directory cannot be listed. | |
14799 | |
14800 ** Changes in minibuffer input | |
14801 | |
14802 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string | |
14803 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an | |
14804 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this | |
14805 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two | |
14806 ways: | |
14807 | |
14808 It is returned if the user enters empty input. | |
14809 It is available through the history command M-n. | |
14810 | |
14811 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer, | |
14812 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional | |
14813 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the | |
14814 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of | |
14815 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer. | |
14816 | |
14817 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an | |
14818 argument in this way. | |
14819 | |
14820 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties | |
14821 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable | |
14822 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil. | |
14823 | |
14824 ** Echo area features | |
14825 | |
14826 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook | |
14827 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the | |
14828 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active | |
14829 after the echo area is cleared. | |
14830 | |
14831 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed | |
14832 in the echo area, or nil if there is none. | |
14833 | |
14834 ** Keyboard input features | |
14835 | |
14836 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was | |
14837 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started. | |
14838 | |
14839 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events | |
14840 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated | |
14841 by keyboard macros. | |
14842 | |
14843 ** Frame-related changes | |
14844 | |
14845 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before | |
14846 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal | |
14847 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg. | |
14848 | |
14849 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time | |
14850 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration | |
14851 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run. | |
14852 | |
14853 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently | |
14854 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the | |
14855 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed | |
14856 in the selected frame. | |
14857 | |
14858 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars | |
14859 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies | |
14860 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on. | |
14861 | |
14862 ** X Windows features | |
14863 | |
14864 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding | |
14865 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of | |
14866 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs. | |
14867 | |
14868 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work. | |
14869 The menu displays the current status of the box or button. | |
14870 | |
14871 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument | |
14872 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return. | |
14873 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster. | |
14874 | |
14875 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern, | |
14876 it is good to supply 1 for this argument. | |
14877 | |
14878 ** Subprocess features | |
14879 | |
14880 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter | |
14881 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this | |
14882 automatically. | |
14883 | |
14884 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command | |
14885 and returns the output from the command as a string. | |
14886 | |
14887 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process, | |
14888 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection. | |
14889 | |
14890 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook | |
14891 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before. | |
14892 | |
14893 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes | |
14894 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it | |
14895 goes after the other menu items. | |
14896 | |
14897 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area | |
14898 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls | |
14899 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks | |
14900 are in use. | |
14901 | |
14902 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a | |
14903 series of several changes--if that seems safe. | |
14904 | |
14905 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and | |
14906 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls | |
14907 form. | |
14908 | |
14909 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION | |
14910 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense, | |
14911 but its hook is still run. | |
14912 | |
14913 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it) | |
14914 for errors that are handled by condition-case. | |
14915 | |
14916 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called | |
14917 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is | |
14918 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case. | |
14919 | |
14920 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that | |
14921 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process | |
14922 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't | |
14923 warned. | |
14924 | |
14925 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own | |
14926 way for Emacs to "ring the bell". | |
14927 | |
14928 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at | |
14929 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for | |
14930 functions like display-time. | |
14931 | |
14932 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file | |
14933 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before. | |
14934 | |
14935 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that | |
14936 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode | |
14937 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit. | |
14938 | |
14939 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code | |
14940 if there is an error in compilation. | |
14941 | |
14942 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and | |
14943 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional | |
14944 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil, | |
14945 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list. | |
14946 | |
14947 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty, | |
14948 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing | |
14949 the *scratch* buffer. | |
14950 | |
14951 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string. | |
14952 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used | |
14953 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important, | |
14954 e.g., in Font Lock mode. | |
14955 | |
14956 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer, | |
14957 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window. | |
14958 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created. | |
14959 | |
14960 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message | |
14961 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the | |
14962 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window | |
14963 and compose-mail-other-frame. | |
14964 | |
14965 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which | |
14966 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The | |
14967 full name of the specified user will be returned. | |
14968 | |
14969 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort | |
14970 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding | |
14971 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found | |
14972 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q | |
14973 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization | |
14974 files at all. | |
14975 | |
14976 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width | |
14977 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field | |
14978 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start | |
14979 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros. | |
14980 | |
14981 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the | |
14982 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad | |
14983 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that | |
14984 is how %S normally pads to two positions. | |
14985 | |
14986 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url. | |
14987 | |
14988 ** imenu.el changes. | |
14989 | |
14990 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an | |
14991 item from menu created by imenu. | |
14992 | |
14993 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the | |
14994 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we | |
14995 select one of those items. | |
14996 | |
14997 * For older news, see the file ONEWS | |
14998 | |
14999 ---------------------------------------------------------------------- | 5755 ---------------------------------------------------------------------- |
15000 Copyright information: | 5756 Copyright information: |
15001 | 5757 |
15002 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, | 5758 Copyright (C) 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 |
15003 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc. | 5759 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
15004 | 5760 |
15005 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies | 5761 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies |
15006 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the | 5762 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the |
15007 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved, | 5763 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved, |
15008 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn. | 5764 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn. |